blob: 61d4e460755d7502c8227193751362c812c87fee [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau991b4782015-10-13 21:48:10 +02005 version 1.7
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau41d5e3a2016-08-14 12:25:21 +02007 2016/08/14
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020054
554. Proxies
564.1. Proxy keywords matrix
574.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
58
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200595. Bind and Server options
605.1. Bind options
615.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200625.3. Server DNS resolution
635.3.1. Global overview
645.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020065
666. HTTP header manipulation
67
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200687. Using ACLs and fetching samples
697.1. ACL basics
707.1.1. Matching booleans
717.1.2. Matching integers
727.1.3. Matching strings
737.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
747.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
757.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
767.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
777.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200787.3.1. Converters
797.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
807.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
817.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
827.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
837.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200847.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085
868. Logging
878.1. Log levels
888.2. Log formats
898.2.1. Default log format
908.2.2. TCP log format
918.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100928.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100938.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200948.3. Advanced logging options
958.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
968.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
978.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
988.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
998.4. Timing events
1008.5. Session state at disconnection
1018.6. Non-printable characters
1028.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1038.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1048.9. Examples of logs
105
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001069. Supported filters
1079.1. Trace
1089.2. HTTP compression
109
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200110
1111. Quick reminder about HTTP
112----------------------------
113
114When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
115fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
116on almost anything found in the contents.
117
118However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
119formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
120correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
121
122
1231.1. The HTTP transaction model
124-------------------------------
125
126The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100127to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200128from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
129connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
130will involve a new connection :
131
132 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
133
134In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
135establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
136by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
137length.
138
139Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
140to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
141however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
142response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
143header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
144
145 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
146
147Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
148power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
149but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200150a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200151
152A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
153keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
154second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
155page :
156
157 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
158
159This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
160latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
161correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
162the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100163server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200164
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100165By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
166connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
167leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
168start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200169
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100170HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
171 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
172 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
173 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
174 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
175 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
176 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
177
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178
1791.2. HTTP request
180-----------------
181
182First, let's consider this HTTP request :
183
184 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100185 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200186 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
187 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
188 3 User-agent: my small browser
189 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
190 5 Accept: image/png
191
192
1931.2.1. The Request line
194-----------------------
195
196Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
197
198 - a METHOD : GET
199 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
200 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
201
202All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
203which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
204followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
205is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
206desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
207the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
208
209The URI itself can have several forms :
210
211 - A "relative URI" :
212
213 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
214
215 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
216 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
217
218 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
219
220 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
221
222 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
223 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
224 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
225 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
226 must accept this form too.
227
228 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
229 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
230 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100231
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200232 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
233 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
234 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
235 other protocols too.
236
237In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
238mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
239on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
240It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
241specific to the language, framework or application in use.
242
243
2441.2.2. The request headers
245--------------------------
246
247The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
248beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
249an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
250Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
251values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
252encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
253the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
254define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
255
256Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
257their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
258"Connection:" header).
259
260The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
261that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
262is one valid form of empty line.
263
264Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
265headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
266about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
267application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
268
269Important note:
270 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
271 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
272 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
273 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
274
275
2761.3. HTTP response
277------------------
278
279An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
280messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
281
282 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100283 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200284 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
285 2 Content-length: 350
286 3 Content-Type: text/html
287
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200288As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
289codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
290response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100291continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
292the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
293following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
294sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
295(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
296correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
297such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
298state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
299over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
300if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
301information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200302
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200303
3041.3.1. The Response line
305------------------------
306
307Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
308
309 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
310 - a status code : 200
311 - a reason : OK
312
313The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200314 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200315 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
316 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
317 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
318 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
319
320Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100321"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200322found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
323messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
324or "Authentication Required".
325
326Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
327
328 Code When / reason
329 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
330 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
331 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
332 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100333 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
334 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200335 400 for an invalid or too large request
336 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
337 accessing the stats page)
338 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
339 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
340 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
341 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
342 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
343 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
344 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
345 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
346 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
347
348The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3494.2).
350
351
3521.3.2. The response headers
353---------------------------
354
355Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
356the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
357details.
358
359
3602. Configuring HAProxy
361----------------------
362
3632.1. Configuration file format
364------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200365
366HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
367
368 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
369 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
370 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
371 "frontend" and "backend".
372
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100373The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
374referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200375delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100376
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200377
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02003782.2. Quoting and escaping
379-------------------------
380
381HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
382many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
383with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
384single quotes.
385
386If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
387them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
388escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
389
390Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
391
392 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
393 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
394 \\ to use a backslash
395 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
396 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
397
398Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
399the interpretation of:
400
401 space as a parameter separator
402 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
403 # hash as a comment start
404
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200405Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
406-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
407backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
408
409Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200410quoting.
411
412Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
413nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
414
415Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
416equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
417
418 Example:
419 # those are equivalents:
420 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
421 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
422 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
423 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
424 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
425
426 # those are equivalents:
427 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
428 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
429 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
430 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
431
432
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004332.3. Environment variables
434--------------------------
435
436HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
437interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
438configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
439optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
440shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
441underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
442
443 Example:
444
445 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
446
447 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
448
449 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
450
451
4522.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200453----------------
454
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100455Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100456values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
457otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
458numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
459for every keyword. Supported units are :
460
461 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
462 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
463 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
464 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
465 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
466 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
467
468
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004692.4. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200470-------------
471
472 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
473 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
474 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
475 global
476 daemon
477 maxconn 256
478
479 defaults
480 mode http
481 timeout connect 5000ms
482 timeout client 50000ms
483 timeout server 50000ms
484
485 frontend http-in
486 bind *:80
487 default_backend servers
488
489 backend servers
490 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
491
492
493 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
494 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
495 global
496 daemon
497 maxconn 256
498
499 defaults
500 mode http
501 timeout connect 5000ms
502 timeout client 50000ms
503 timeout server 50000ms
504
505 listen http-in
506 bind *:80
507 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
508
509
510Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
511
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100512 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200513
514
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005153. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200516--------------------
517
518Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
519are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
520of them have command-line equivalents.
521
522The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
523
524 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200525 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200526 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200527 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200528 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200529 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200530 - description
531 - deviceatlas-json-file
532 - deviceatlas-log-level
533 - deviceatlas-separator
534 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900535 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200536 - gid
537 - group
538 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200539 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100540 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200541 - lua-load
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200542 - nbproc
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200543 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200544 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100545 - presetenv
546 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200547 - uid
548 - ulimit-n
549 - user
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100550 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200551 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200552 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
553 - ssl-default-bind-options
554 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
555 - ssl-default-server-options
556 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100557 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100558 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100559 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100560 - 51degrees-data-file
561 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200562 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200563 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100564
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200565 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200566 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200567 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200568 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100569 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100570 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100571 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200572 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200573 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200574 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200575 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200576 - noepoll
577 - nokqueue
578 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100579 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300580 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000581 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200582 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200583 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200584 - server-state-file
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200585 - tune.buffers.limit
586 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200587 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200588 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100589 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100590 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200591 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100592 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100593 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100594 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100595 - tune.lua.session-timeout
596 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200597 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100598 - tune.maxaccept
599 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200600 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200601 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200602 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100603 - tune.rcvbuf.client
604 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100605 - tune.recv_enough
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100606 - tune.sndbuf.client
607 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100608 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100609 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200610 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100611 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200612 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200613 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200614 - tune.vars.global-max-size
615 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
616 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
617 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100618 - tune.zlib.memlevel
619 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100620
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200621 * Debugging
622 - debug
623 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200624
625
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006263.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200627------------------------------------
628
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200629ca-base <dir>
630 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200631 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
632 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200633
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200634chroot <jail dir>
635 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
636 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
637 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
638 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
639 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
640 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100641
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100642cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
643 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
644 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
645 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100646 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32 or
647 64, depending on the machine's word size, and any process IDs above nbproc
648 are ignored. It is possible to specify all processes at once using "all",
649 only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like with the
650 "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are CPU sets.
651 Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a range with
652 two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers or ranges
653 may be specified, and the processes will be allowed to bind to all of them.
654 Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map"
655 directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100656
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200657crt-base <dir>
658 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
659 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
660 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
661
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200662daemon
663 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
664 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
665 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
666
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200667deviceatlas-json-file <path>
668 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
669 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by Haproxy process.
670
671deviceatlas-log-level <value>
672 Sets the level of informations returned by the API. This directive is
673 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
674
675deviceatlas-separator <char>
676 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
677 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
678
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100679deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200680 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
681 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
682 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100683
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900684external-check
685 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
686 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
687 See "option external-check".
688
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200689gid <number>
690 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
691 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
692 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100693 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
694 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200695 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100696
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200697group <group name>
698 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
699 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100700
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200701log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200702 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
703 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100704 configured with "log global".
705
706 <address> can be one of:
707
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100708 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100709 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
710 port).
711
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100712 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
713 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
714 port).
715
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100716 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
717 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
718 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
719 writeable).
720
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200721 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
722 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100723
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200724 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
725 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
726 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
727 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
728 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
729 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
730 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
731 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
732 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
733 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
734 JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
735
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200736 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
737 one of the following :
738
739 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
740 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
741
742 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
743 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
744
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100745 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200746
747 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
748 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
749 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
750
751 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200752 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
753 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
754 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
755 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
756 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
757 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200758
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200759 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200760
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100761log-send-hostname [<string>]
762 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
763 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
764 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
765 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
766 the logs.
767
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000768log-tag <string>
769 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
770 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
771 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100772 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000773
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100774lua-load <file>
775 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
776 used multiple times.
777
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200778nbproc <number>
779 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
780 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
781 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
782 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
783 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
784
785pidfile <pidfile>
786 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
787 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
788 starting the process. See also "daemon".
789
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100790presetenv <name> <value>
791 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
792 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
793 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
794 and "unsetenv".
795
796resetenv [<name> ...]
797 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
798 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
799 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
800 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
801 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
802 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
803 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
804 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
805
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100806stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200807 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
808 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
809 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
810 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
811 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
812 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100813 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +0200814 word size (32 or 64). A better option consists in using the "process" setting
815 of the "stats socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200816
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200817server-state-base <directory>
818 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200819 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
820 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200821
822server-state-file <file>
823 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
824 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
825 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
826 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
827 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
828 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
829 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
830 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200831 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
832 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200833
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100834setenv <name> <value>
835 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
836 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
837 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
838 and "unsetenv".
839
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100840ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
841 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
842 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300843 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100844 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
845 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
846 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
847 "bind" keyword for more information.
848
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100849ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
850 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
851 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
852 keyword to see available options.
853
854 Example:
855 global
856 ssl-default-bind-options no-sslv3 no-tls-tickets
857
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100858ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
859 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
860 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300861 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100862 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
863 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
864 information.
865
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100866ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
867 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
868 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
869 keyword to see available options.
870
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200871ssl-dh-param-file <file>
872 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
873 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
874 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
875 which do not explicitely define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
876 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200877 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
878 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
879 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
880 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200881 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
882 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
883 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
884
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100885ssl-server-verify [none|required]
886 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
887 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
888 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
889
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200890stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
891 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
892 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
893 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +0200894 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
895 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200896
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200897 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
898 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
899 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200900
901stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
902 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
903 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100904 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200905
906stats maxconn <connections>
907 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
908 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
909
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200910uid <number>
911 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
912 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
913 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
914 one. See also "gid" and "user".
915
916ulimit-n <number>
917 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
918 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
919 option.
920
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100921unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
922 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
923
924 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
925 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
926 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
927 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
928 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
929 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
930 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
931 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
932 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
933 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
934
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100935unsetenv [<name> ...]
936 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
937 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
938 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
939 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
940 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
941 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
942 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
943
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200944user <user name>
945 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
946 See also "uid" and "group".
947
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200948node <name>
949 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
950
951 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
952 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
953 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
954 traffic.
955
956description <text>
957 Add a text that describes the instance.
958
959 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
960 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
961 "<" and ">" characters.
962
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +010096351degrees-data-file <file path>
964 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
965 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevavnt permissions.
966
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200967 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100968 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
969
97051degrees-property-name-list [<string>]
971 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
972 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
973 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
974
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200975 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100976 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
977
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +020097851degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100979 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
980 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
981
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200982 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
983 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
984
98551degrees-cache-size <number>
986 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
987 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
988 By default, this cache is disabled.
989
990 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100991 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
992
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200993
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009943.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200995-----------------------
996
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200997max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
998 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
999 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1000 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1001 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1002 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1003 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1004 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1005 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1006
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001007maxconn <number>
1008 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1009 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1010 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001011 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1012 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1013 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1014 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001015 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will default to the value
1016 set in DEFAULT_MAXCONN at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) if no memory
1017 limit is enforced, or will be computed based on the memory limit, the buffer
1018 size, memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use or not of SSL
1019 and the associated maxsslconn (which can also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001020
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001021maxconnrate <number>
1022 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1023 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1024 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1025 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1026 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1027 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1028 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1029 fairness.
1030
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001031maxcomprate <number>
1032 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001033 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001034 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1035 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1036 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
1037 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
1038 default value.
1039
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001040maxcompcpuusage <number>
1041 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1042 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1043 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1044 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1045 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1046 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1047 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1048 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1049
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001050maxpipes <number>
1051 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1052 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1053 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1054 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1055 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1056 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1057
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001058maxsessrate <number>
1059 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1060 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1061 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1062 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1063 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1064 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1065 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1066 fairness.
1067
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001068maxsslconn <number>
1069 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1070 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1071 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1072 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1073 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1074 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1075 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001076 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1077 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1078 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1079 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1080 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1081 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1082 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001083
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001084maxsslrate <number>
1085 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1086 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1087 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1088 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1089 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1090 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1091 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1092 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1093 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1094 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1095
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001096maxzlibmem <number>
1097 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1098 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1099 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001100 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1101 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1102 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1103
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001104noepoll
1105 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1106 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001107 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001108
1109nokqueue
1110 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1111 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1112 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1113
1114nopoll
1115 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1116 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001117 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001118 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001119
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001120nosplice
1121 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
1122 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
1123 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001124 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001125 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1126 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1127 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1128 "option splice-response".
1129
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001130nogetaddrinfo
1131 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1132 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1133
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001134noreuseport
1135 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1136 command line argument "-dR".
1137
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001138spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001139 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1140 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1141 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1142 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1143 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1144 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001145
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001146tune.buffers.limit <number>
1147 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1148 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1149 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1150 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1151 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
1152 behaviour. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
1153 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1154 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1155 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1156 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1157 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1158 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1159 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1160 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1161 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1162
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001163tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1164 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1165 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1166 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1167 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1168
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001169tune.bufsize <number>
1170 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1171 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1172 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1173 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1174 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1175 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1176 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
1177 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001178 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
1179 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
1180 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001181
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001182tune.chksize <number>
1183 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1184 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1185 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1186 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1187 checks whenever possible.
1188
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001189tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1190 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1191 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1192 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1193 this value. The default value is 1.
1194
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001195tune.http.cookielen <number>
1196 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1197 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1198 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1199 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1200 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1201 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1202 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1203 to change this value.
1204
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001205tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1206 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1207 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1208 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1209 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1210 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1211 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
1212 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
1213 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
1214 limit too high.
1215
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001216tune.idletimer <timeout>
1217 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1218 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1219 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1220 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1221 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1222 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
1223 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
1224 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
1225 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1226
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001227tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1228 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
1229 instructions executed. This permits interruptng a long script and allows the
1230 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1231 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
1232 executes some Lua code but more reactivity is required, this value can be
1233 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1234 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1235
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001236tune.lua.maxmem
1237 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1238 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1239 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1240 memory.
1241
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001242tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1243 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001244 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1245 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
1246 not taked in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001247
1248tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1249 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1250 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1251 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1252 check servers.
1253
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001254tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1255 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1256 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1257 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
1258 not taked in account. The default timeout is 4s.
1259
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001260tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001261 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1262 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1263 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1264 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1265 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1266 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1267 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1268 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1269 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1270 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001271
1272tune.maxpollevents <number>
1273 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1274 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1275 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1276 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1277 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1278
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001279tune.maxrewrite <number>
1280 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1281 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1282 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1283 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1284 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1285 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1286 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1287 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1288 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1289 bufsize.
1290
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001291tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1292 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1293 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1294 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1295 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1296 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1297 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1298 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1299 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1300 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1301 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1302 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1303 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1304 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1305 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1306 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1307 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1308 setting this parameter to 0.
1309
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001310tune.pipesize <number>
1311 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1312 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1313 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1314 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1315 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1316 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1317
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001318tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1319tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1320 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1321 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1322 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1323 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1324 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1325 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1326 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1327
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001328tune.recv_enough <number>
1329 Haproxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
1330 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1331 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1332 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1333 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1334
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001335tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1336tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1337 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1338 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1339 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1340 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1341 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1342 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1343 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1344 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1345 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1346 notifying haproxy again.
1347
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001348tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001349 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1350 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1351 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001352 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001353 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
1354 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
1355 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1356 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1357 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001358 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1359 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001360
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001361tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1362 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
1363 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1364 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1365 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1366 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1367 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1368
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001369tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1370 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001371 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001372 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1373 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1374 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1375 being used for too long.
1376
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001377tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1378 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1379 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1380 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1381 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1382 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1383 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1384 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1385 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1386 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1387 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001388 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1389 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001390
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001391tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1392 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1393 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1394 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1395 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1396 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1397 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1398 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001399 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1400 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001401
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001402tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1403 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1404 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1405 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1406 1000 entries.
1407
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001408tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
1409tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1410tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1411tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001412 These four tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1413 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available
1414 for all scopes. "sess" limits the memory for the session scope, "txn" for
1415 the transaction scope, and "reqres" limits the memory for each request or
1416 response processing.
1417 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits
1418 include the finer grained ones: "sess" includes "txn", and "txn" includes
1419 "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001420
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001421 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1422 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1423 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1424 all available space is consumed.
1425 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
1426 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
1427 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001428
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001429tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1430 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001431 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001432 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1433 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1434 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1435
1436tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1437 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1438 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1439 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1440 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001441
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014423.3. Debugging
1443--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001444
1445debug
1446 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1447 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1448 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1449 system startup.
1450
1451quiet
1452 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1453 line argument "-q".
1454
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001455
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010014563.4. Userlists
1457--------------
1458It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1459http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1460it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1461
1462userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001463 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001464 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1465
1466group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001467 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001468 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1469 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1470
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001471user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1472 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001473 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1474 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001475 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1476 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001477 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001478 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001479
1480
1481 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001482 userlist L1
1483 group G1 users tiger,scott
1484 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001485
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001486 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1487 user scott insecure-password elgato
1488 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001489
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001490 userlist L2
1491 group G1
1492 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001493
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001494 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1495 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1496 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001497
1498 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001499
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001500
15013.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001502----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02001503It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
1504several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
1505instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
1506values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
1507automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
1508In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
1509using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
1510tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
1511reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
1512Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
1513that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
1514each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001515
1516peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001517 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001518 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1519
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001520disabled
1521 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
1522 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
1523 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
1524
1525enable
1526 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
1527
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001528peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1529 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1530 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1531 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1532 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1533 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1534 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1535
1536 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1537 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1538
1539 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1540 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1541 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1542 across all peers.
1543
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001544 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1545 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001546
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001547 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001548 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001549 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1550 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1551 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001552
1553 backend mybackend
1554 mode tcp
1555 balance roundrobin
1556 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1557 stick on src
1558
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001559 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1560 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001561
1562
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090015633.6. Mailers
1564------------
1565It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
1566If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
1567in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
1568
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02001569mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001570 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
1571 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
1572
1573mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
1574 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
1575
1576 Example:
1577 mailers mymailers
1578 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
1579 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
1580
1581 backend mybackend
1582 mode tcp
1583 balance roundrobin
1584
1585 email-alert mailers mymailers
1586 email-alert from test1@horms.org
1587 email-alert to test2@horms.org
1588
1589 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1590 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
1591
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01001592timeout mail <time>
1593 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
1594 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
1595 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
1596 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
1597
1598 Example:
1599 mailers mymailers
1600 timeout mail 20s
1601 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001602
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016034. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001604----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001605
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001606Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02001607 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001608 - frontend <name>
1609 - backend <name>
1610 - listen <name>
1611
1612A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1613its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1614section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001615section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001616
1617A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1618connections.
1619
1620A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1621to forward incoming connections.
1622
1623A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1624parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1625
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001626All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1627'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1628case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1629
1630Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1631logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1632proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1633However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1634name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1635
1636Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1637and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001638bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001639protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1640modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1641arbitrary criteria.
1642
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001643In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1644a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1645the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1646
1647 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1648 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1649 between responses and new requests.
1650
1651 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1652 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1653 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1654 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1655
1656 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1657 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1658 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1659
1660 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1661 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1662 client-facing connection remains open.
1663
1664 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1665 after the end of the response.
1666
1667The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1668frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1669following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1670weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1671
1672 Backend mode
1673
1674 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1675 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1676 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1677 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1678 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1679 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1680 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1681 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1682 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1683 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1684 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1685
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001686
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001687
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016884.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1689--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001690
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001691The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1692limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1693they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1694limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001695marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001696option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001697and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1698with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1699specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001700
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001701
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001702 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1703------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1704acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02001705appsession - - - -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001706backlog X X X -
1707balance X - X X
1708bind - X X -
1709bind-process X X X X
1710block - X X X
1711capture cookie - X X -
1712capture request header - X X -
1713capture response header - X X -
1714clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001715compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001716contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1717cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02001718declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001719default-server X - X X
1720default_backend X X X -
1721description - X X X
1722disabled X X X X
1723dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001724email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09001725email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001726email-alert mailers X X X X
1727email-alert myhostname X X X X
1728email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001729enabled X X X X
1730errorfile X X X X
1731errorloc X X X X
1732errorloc302 X X X X
1733-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1734errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001735force-persist - X X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001736filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001737fullconn X - X X
1738grace X X X X
1739hash-type X - X X
1740http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001741http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001742http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001743http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001744http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02001745http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001746http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001747id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001748ignore-persist - X X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001749load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001750log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01001751log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001752log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001753log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001754max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001755maxconn X X X -
1756mode X X X X
1757monitor fail - X X -
1758monitor-net X X X -
1759monitor-uri X X X -
1760option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1761option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1762option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1763option allbackups (*) X - X X
1764option checkcache (*) X - X X
1765option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1766option contstats (*) X X X -
1767option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1768option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1769option forceclose (*) X X X X
1770-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1771option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02001772option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02001773option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001774option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001775option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001776option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001777option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001778option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001779option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1780option httpchk X - X X
1781option httpclose (*) X X X X
1782option httplog X X X X
1783option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001784option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001785option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001786option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001787option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1788option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1789option logasap (*) X X X -
1790option mysql-check X - X X
1791option nolinger (*) X X X X
1792option originalto X X X X
1793option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02001794option pgsql-check X - X X
1795option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001796option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001797option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001798option smtpchk X - X X
1799option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1800option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1801option splice-request (*) X X X X
1802option splice-response (*) X X X X
1803option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1804option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1805-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001806option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001807option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1808option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1809option tcpka X X X X
1810option tcplog X X X X
1811option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001812external-check command X - X X
1813external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001814persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1815rate-limit sessions X X X -
1816redirect - X X X
1817redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1818redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1819reqadd - X X X
1820reqallow - X X X
1821reqdel - X X X
1822reqdeny - X X X
1823reqiallow - X X X
1824reqidel - X X X
1825reqideny - X X X
1826reqipass - X X X
1827reqirep - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001828reqitarpit - X X X
1829reqpass - X X X
1830reqrep - X X X
1831-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001832reqtarpit - X X X
1833retries X - X X
1834rspadd - X X X
1835rspdel - X X X
1836rspdeny - X X X
1837rspidel - X X X
1838rspideny - X X X
1839rspirep - X X X
1840rsprep - X X X
1841server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001842server-state-file-name X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001843source X - X X
1844srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02001845stats admin - X X X
1846stats auth X X X X
1847stats enable X X X X
1848stats hide-version X X X X
1849stats http-request - X X X
1850stats realm X X X X
1851stats refresh X X X X
1852stats scope X X X X
1853stats show-desc X X X X
1854stats show-legends X X X X
1855stats show-node X X X X
1856stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001857-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1858stick match - - X X
1859stick on - - X X
1860stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001861stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001862stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02001863tcp-check connect - - X X
1864tcp-check expect - - X X
1865tcp-check send - - X X
1866tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001867tcp-request connection - X X -
1868tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001869tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001870tcp-response content - - X X
1871tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001872timeout check X - X X
1873timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001874timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001875timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1876timeout connect X - X X
1877timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1878timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1879timeout http-request X X X X
1880timeout queue X - X X
1881timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001882timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001883timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1884timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001885timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001886transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001887unique-id-format X X X -
1888unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001889use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001890use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001891------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1892 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001893
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001894
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018954.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1896---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001897
1898This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1899
1900
1901acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1902 Declare or complete an access list.
1903 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1904 no | yes | yes | yes
1905 Example:
1906 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1907 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1908 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1909
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001910 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001911
1912
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001913appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1914 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001915 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1916 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1917 no | no | yes | yes
1918 Arguments :
1919 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1920 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1921
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001922 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001923 checked in each cookie value.
1924
1925 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1926 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1927 milliseconds.
1928
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001929 request-learn
1930 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1931 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1932 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1933 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1934 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1935 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1936
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001937 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1938 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1939 data following this prefix.
1940
1941 Example :
1942 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1943
1944 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1945 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1946
1947 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1948 2 modes are currently supported :
1949 - path-parameters :
1950 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1951 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1952 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1953 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1954 - query-string :
1955 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1956 query string.
1957
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02001958 As of version 1.6, appsessions was removed. It is more flexible and more
1959 convenient to use stick-tables instead, and stick-tables support multi-master
1960 replication and data conservation across reloads, which appsessions did not.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001961
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001962 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1963 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001964
1965
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001966backlog <conns>
1967 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1968 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1969 yes | yes | yes | no
1970 Arguments :
1971 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1972 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001973 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001974
1975 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1976 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1977 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1978 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1979 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1980 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1981 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1982 backlog parameter.
1983
1984 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1985 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1986 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1987
1988 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1989
1990
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001991balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001992balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001993 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1994 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1995 yes | no | yes | yes
1996 Arguments :
1997 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1998 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1999 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2000 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2001
2002 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2003 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2004 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2005 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002006 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002007 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002008 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2009 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2010 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2011 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2012 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2013 it, so that you don't worry.
2014
2015 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2016 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2017 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2018 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2019 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2020 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2021 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2022 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002023
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002024 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2025 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2026 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2027 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2028 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2029 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2030 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2031 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2032
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002033 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002034 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002035 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2036 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002037 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002038 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2039 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2040 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2041 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2042 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002043 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2044 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2045 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2046 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2047 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2048 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002049
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002050 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2051 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2052 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2053 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2054 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2055 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2056 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2057 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002058 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002059 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002060 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2061 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2062 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002063
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002064 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2065 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2066 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2067 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2068 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2069 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2070 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2071 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2072 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2073 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2074 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2075 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002076
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002077 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002078 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2079 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2080 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2081 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2082 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2083 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2084 URIs start with a leading "/".
2085
2086 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2087 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2088 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2089 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2090
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002091 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002092 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2093
2094 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002095 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2096 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002097 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2098 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2099 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2100 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002101 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002102 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2103 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002104
2105 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2106 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2107 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2108 server will receive the request.
2109
2110 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2111 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2112 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2113 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2114 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002115 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2116 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2117 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002118
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002119 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2120 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2121 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2122 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2123 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002124
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002125 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002126 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2127 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2128 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2129
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002130 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2131 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2132 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2133
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002134 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002135 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002136 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2137 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2138 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2139 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2140 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2141 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002142 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002143 used instead.
2144
2145 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2146 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2147 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2148 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2149
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002150 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2151 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2152 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2153
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002154 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002155
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002156 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002157 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2158 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002159
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002160 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2161 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2162 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002163
2164 Examples :
2165 balance roundrobin
2166 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002167 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002168 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2169 balance hdr(host)
2170 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002171
2172 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2173 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2174
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002175 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002176 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2177 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2178 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2179 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2180
2181 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2182 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2183 defaults to 16 kB.
2184
2185 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2186 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2187
2188 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2189 Round Robin.
2190
2191 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
2192 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2193 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2194 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2195
2196 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2197
2198 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002199 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002200 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2201 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2202 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002203
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002204 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002205
2206
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002207bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2208bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002209 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2210 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2211 no | yes | yes | no
2212 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002213 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2214 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2215 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2216 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002217 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002218 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2219 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2220 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2221 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2222 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2223 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2224 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002225 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2226 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2227 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2228 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2229 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2230 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2231 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002232 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2233 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2234 be listening.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002235 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2236 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2237 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002238
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002239 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2240 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002241 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2242 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2243 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002244 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2245 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2246 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2247 the range.
2248
2249 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2250 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2251 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2252 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2253 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2254 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2255 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002256 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002257 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002258
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002259 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
2260 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
2261 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2262 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2263 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2264 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2265 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2266 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2267
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002268 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2269 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2270 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2271 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002272
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002273 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2274 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2275 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2276 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2277 in a frontend.
2278
2279 Example :
2280 listen http_proxy
2281 bind :80,:443
2282 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002283 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002284
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002285 listen http_https_proxy
2286 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002287 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002288
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002289 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2290 bind ipv6@:80
2291 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2292 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2293
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002294 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002295 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002296
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002297 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2298 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2299 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2300 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2301 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2302
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002303 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002304 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002305
2306
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002307bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002308 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2309 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2310 yes | yes | yes | yes
2311 Arguments :
2312 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2313 may be used to override a default value.
2314
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002315 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002316 option may be combined with other numbers.
2317
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002318 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002319 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2320 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2321 missing from all processes.
2322
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002323 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002324 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002325 the machine's word size. If a proxy is bound to process
2326 numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it will
2327 either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
2328 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002329
2330 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2331 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2332 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2333 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2334 and 'even' instances.
2335
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002336 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2337 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2338 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2339 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002340
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002341 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2342 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2343
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002344 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2345 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2346 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2347
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002348 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2349 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2350
2351 Example :
2352 listen app_ip1
2353 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002354 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002355
2356 listen app_ip2
2357 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002358 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002359
2360 listen management
2361 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002362 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002363
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002364 listen management
2365 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2366 bind-process 1-4
2367
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002368 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002369
2370
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002371block { if | unless } <condition>
2372 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2373 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2374 no | yes | yes | yes
2375
2376 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2377 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002378 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002379 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002380 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
2381 "block" statements per instance.
2382
2383 Example:
2384 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2385 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2386 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2387 block if invalid_src || local_dst
2388
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002389 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002390
2391
2392capture cookie <name> len <length>
2393 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2394 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2395 no | yes | yes | no
2396 Arguments :
2397 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2398 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2399 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2400 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
2401 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
2402
2403 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2404 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2405 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2406 right if it exceeds <length>.
2407
2408 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2409 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2410 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2411 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2412
2413 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2414 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2415 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2416
2417 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2418 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2419 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002420 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2421 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2422 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002423
2424 Example:
2425 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2426
2427 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002428 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002429
2430
2431capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002432 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002433 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2434 no | yes | yes | no
2435 Arguments :
2436 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002437 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002438 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2439 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2440 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2441
2442 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2443 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2444 it exceeds <length>.
2445
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002446 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002447 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2448 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002449 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2450 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2451 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2452 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002453 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002454 environments to find where the request came from.
2455
2456 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2457 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2458 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2459 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002460
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002461 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2462 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2463 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2464 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2465 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002466
2467 Example:
2468 capture request header Host len 15
2469 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01002470 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002471
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002472 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002473 about logging.
2474
2475
2476capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002477 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002478 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2479 no | yes | yes | no
2480 Arguments :
2481 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002482 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002483 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2484 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2485 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2486
2487 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2488 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2489 it exceeds <length>.
2490
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002491 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002492 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2493 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2494 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002495 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2496 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2497 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2498 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002499
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002500 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2501 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2502 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2503 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2504 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002505
2506 Example:
2507 capture response header Content-length len 9
2508 capture response header Location len 15
2509
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002510 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002511 about logging.
2512
2513
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002514clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002515 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2516 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2517 yes | yes | yes | no
2518 Arguments :
2519 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2520 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2521 as explained at the top of this document.
2522
2523 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2524 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2525 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2526 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2527 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2528 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2529 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2530 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002531 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002532 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2533 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2534
2535 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2536 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2537 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2538 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2539 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2540 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2541
2542 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2543 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2544
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002545 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2546 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002547
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002548compression algo <algorithm> ...
2549compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002550compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002551 Enable HTTP compression.
2552 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2553 yes | yes | yes | yes
2554 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002555 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2556 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2557 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2558
2559 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002560 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
2561 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2562 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002563
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002564 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002565 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002566
2567 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2568 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
2569 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
2570 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
2571 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002572 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002573
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002574 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
2575 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
2576 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
2577 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
2578 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
2579 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
2580 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002581 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002582
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002583 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002584 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002585 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2586 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2587 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2588 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2589 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002590
2591 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2592 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2593 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2594 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2595 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002596 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2597 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2598 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2599 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2600 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02002601 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
2602 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002603
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002604 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002605 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2606 "Accept-Encoding" header
2607 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002608 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002609 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2610 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002611 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2612 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2613 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2614 "multipart"
2615 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2616 header
2617 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2618 and later
2619 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2620 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002621
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002622 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2623 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002624
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002625 Examples :
2626 compression algo gzip
2627 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002628
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002629
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002630contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002631 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2632 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2633 yes | no | yes | yes
2634 Arguments :
2635 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2636 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2637 as explained at the top of this document.
2638
2639 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002640 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002641 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002642 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2643 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2644 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2645 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2646
2647 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2648 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2649 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2650 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2651 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2652 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2653
2654 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2655 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2656 instead.
2657
2658 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2659 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2660
2661
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002662cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002663 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2664 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002665 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2666 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2667 yes | no | yes | yes
2668 Arguments :
2669 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2670 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2671 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2672 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2673 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2674 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2675 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2676 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2677 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2678
2679 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2680 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2681 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2682 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2683 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2684 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01002685 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
2686 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
2687 behaviour is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
2688 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
2689 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002690
2691 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002692 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002693
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002694 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002695 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2696 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2697 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2698 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2699 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2700 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2701 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2702 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2703 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2704 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002705
2706 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2707 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2708 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2709 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2710 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2711 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2712 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2713 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2714 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01002715 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002716 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2717 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2718 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002719
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002720 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2721 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2722 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002723 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2724 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2725 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2726 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002727 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2728 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2729 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002730
2731 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2732 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2733 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2734 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2735 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2736 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2737 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2738 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2739 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2740
2741 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2742 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2743 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2744 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2745 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2746 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2747 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2748 persistence cookie in the cache.
2749 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2750
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002751 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2752 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2753 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2754 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2755 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2756 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2757 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2758 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2759 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2760 they logout.
2761
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002762 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2763 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2764 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2765 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2766
2767 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2768 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2769 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2770 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2771 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2772 this attribute.
2773
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002774 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002775 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002776 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2777 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2778 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2779 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2780 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2781 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002782
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002783 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2784 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2785 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2786 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2787 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2788 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2789 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2790 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2791 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2792 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2793 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2794 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2795 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2796 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2797 the site.
2798
2799 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2800 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2801 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2802 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2803 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2804 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2805 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2806 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2807 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2808 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2809 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2810 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2811 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2812 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2813 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2814 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2815
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002816 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2817 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2818 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2819 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002820
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002821 Examples :
2822 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2823 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2824 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002825 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002826
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002827 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002828
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002829
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002830declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
2831 Declares a capture slot.
2832 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2833 no | yes | yes | no
2834 Arguments:
2835 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
2836
2837 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
2838 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
2839 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
2840 for use in the response.
2841
2842 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02002843 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002844 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
2845
2846
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002847default-server [param*]
2848 Change default options for a server in a backend
2849 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2850 yes | no | yes | yes
2851 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002852 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2853 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2854 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2855 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002856
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002857 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002858 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2859
2860 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002861
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002862
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002863default_backend <backend>
2864 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2865 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2866 yes | yes | yes | no
2867 Arguments :
2868 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2869
2870 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2871 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2872 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2873 will catch all undetermined requests.
2874
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002875 Example :
2876
2877 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2878 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2879 default_backend dynamic
2880
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02002881 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002882
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002883
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002884description <string>
2885 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2886 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2887 no | yes | yes | yes
2888 Arguments : string
2889
2890 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
2891 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
2892 it describes.
2893 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
2894
2895
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002896disabled
2897 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2898 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2899 yes | yes | yes | yes
2900 Arguments : none
2901
2902 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2903 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2904 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2905 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2906 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2907 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2908 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2909
2910 See also : "enabled"
2911
2912
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002913dispatch <address>:<port>
2914 Set a default server address
2915 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2916 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002917 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002918
2919 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2920 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2921 during start-up.
2922
2923 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2924 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2925 possible with normal servers.
2926
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002927 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002928 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2929 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2930 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2931 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2932
2933 See also : "server"
2934
2935
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002936enabled
2937 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2938 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2939 yes | yes | yes | yes
2940 Arguments : none
2941
2942 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2943 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2944
2945 See also : "disabled"
2946
2947
2948errorfile <code> <file>
2949 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2950 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2951 yes | yes | yes | yes
2952 Arguments :
2953 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
CJ Ess108b1dd2015-04-07 12:03:37 -04002954 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
2955 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002956
2957 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002958 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002959 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002960 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2961 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002962
2963 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2964 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2965 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2966
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002967 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2968
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002969 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2970 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2971 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2972 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2973
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002974 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2975 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2976 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2977 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2978 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2979 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2980
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002981 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2982 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2983 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002984 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002985 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2986
2987 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2988
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002989 Example :
2990 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01002991 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002992 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2993 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2994
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002995
2996errorloc <code> <url>
2997errorloc302 <code> <url>
2998 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2999 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3000 yes | yes | yes | yes
3001 Arguments :
3002 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003003 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003004
3005 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3006 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3007 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3008 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
3009 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
3010
3011 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3012 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3013 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3014
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003015 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3016
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003017 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3018 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3019 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3020 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003021 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003022 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3023 request.
3024
3025 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3026
3027
3028errorloc303 <code> <url>
3029 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3030 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3031 yes | yes | yes | yes
3032 Arguments :
3033 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
3034 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
3035
3036 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3037 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3038 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3039 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
3040 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
3041
3042 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3043 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3044 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3045
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003046 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3047
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003048 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3049 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3050 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3051 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003052 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003053
3054 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3055
3056
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003057email-alert from <emailaddr>
3058 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
3059 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
3060 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3061 yes | yes | yes | yes
3062
3063 Arguments :
3064
3065 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3066
3067 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3068 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3069
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003070 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003071 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3072 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003073
3074
3075email-alert level <level>
3076 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3077 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3078 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3079 yes | yes | yes | yes
3080
3081 Arguments :
3082
3083 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3084 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3085 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3086
3087 By default level is alert
3088
3089 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3090 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3091 for the proxy.
3092
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003093 Alerts are sent when :
3094
3095 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3096 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3097 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3098 is notice or lower
3099 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3100 and a health check status update occurs
3101
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003102 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3103 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003104 section 3.6 about mailers.
3105
3106
3107email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3108 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3109 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3110 yes | yes | yes | yes
3111
3112 Arguments :
3113
3114 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3115
3116 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3117 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3118
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003119 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3120 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003121
3122
3123email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3124 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3125 mailers.
3126 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3127 yes | yes | yes | yes
3128
3129 Arguments :
3130
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003131 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003132
3133 By default the systems hostname is used.
3134
3135 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3136 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3137 for the proxy.
3138
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003139 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3140 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003141
3142
3143email-alert to <emailaddr>
3144 Declare both the recipent address in the envelope and to address in the
3145 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3146 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3147 yes | yes | yes | yes
3148
3149 Arguments :
3150
3151 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3152
3153 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3154 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3155
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003156 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003157 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3158
3159
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003160force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3161 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3162 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3163 no | yes | yes | yes
3164
3165 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3166 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3167 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3168 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3169 marked down for maintenance operations.
3170
3171 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3172 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3173 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3174 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3175 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3176 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3177 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3178 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3179 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3180
3181 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3182 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3183 is used.
3184
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003185 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003186 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003187
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003188
3189filter <name> [param*]
3190 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3191 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3192 no | yes | yes | yes
3193 Arguments :
3194 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3195 referenced in section 9.
3196
3197 <param*> is a list of parameters accpeted by the filter <name>. The
3198 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
3199 filter. Please refer to the documention of the corresponding
3200 filter (section 9) from all details on the supported parameters.
3201
3202 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3203 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3204
3205 Example:
3206 listen
3207 bind *:80
3208
3209 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3210 filter compression
3211 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3212
3213 compression algo gzip
3214 compression offload
3215
3216 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3217
3218 See also : section 9.
3219
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003220
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003221fullconn <conns>
3222 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3223 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3224 yes | no | yes | yes
3225 Arguments :
3226 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3227 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3228
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003229 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003230 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003231 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003232 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3233 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3234 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3235 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3236 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003237 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003238
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003239 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3240 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003241 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3242 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3243 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003244
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003245 Example :
3246 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3247 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3248 # connections.
3249 backend dynamic
3250 fullconn 10000
3251 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3252 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3253
3254 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3255
3256
3257grace <time>
3258 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3259 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003260 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003261 Arguments :
3262 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3263 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3264 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3265
3266 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3267 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003268 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003269 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3270
3271 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3272 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3273 simplify it.
3274
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003275
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003276hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003277 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3278 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3279 yes | no | yes | yes
3280 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003281 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3282 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003283
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003284 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3285 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3286 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3287 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3288 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3289 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3290 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3291 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3292 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3293 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003294
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003295 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3296 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3297 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3298 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3299 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3300 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3301 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3302 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3303 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3304 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3305 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3306 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3307 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003308 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3309 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003310
3311 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3312
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003313 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003314 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3315 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3316 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003317 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3318 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3319 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003320
3321 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3322 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003323 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3324 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3325 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3326 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3327
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003328 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3329 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3330 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3331 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3332 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3333 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3334 parameter.
3335
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003336 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3337 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3338 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3339 used on strings.
3340
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003341 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3342
3343 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3344 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3345 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3346 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3347 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3348 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3349 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3350 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3351 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3352 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3353 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3354 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003355
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003356 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3357 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3358 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003359
3360 See also : "balance", "server"
3361
3362
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003363http-check disable-on-404
3364 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3365 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003366 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003367 Arguments : none
3368
3369 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3370 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3371 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3372 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3373 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3374 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3375 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
3376 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003377 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
3378 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
3379 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
3380
3381 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
3382
3383
3384http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003385 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003386 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02003387 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003388 Arguments :
3389 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3390 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003391 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003392 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
3393 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
3394 details on the supported keywords.
3395
3396 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3397 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3398 with the usual backslash ('\').
3399
3400 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
3401 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
3402 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
3403 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
3404 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
3405
3406 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003407 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003408 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
3409 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3410 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3411
3412 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003413 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003414 response's status code matches the expression. If the
3415 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3416 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3417 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
3418
3419 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003420 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003421 response's body contains this exact string. If the
3422 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3423 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3424 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
3425 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
3426 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
3427 trace).
3428
3429 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003430 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003431 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
3432 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
3433 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
3434 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
3435 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
3436 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
3437
3438 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
3439 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
3440 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
3441 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
3442 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
3443 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
3444 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3445 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
3446
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01003447 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
3448 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
3449 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
3450
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003451 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
3452 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
3453
3454 Examples :
3455 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003456 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003457
3458 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003459 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003460
3461 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003462 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003463
3464 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003465 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003466
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003467 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003468
3469
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003470http-check send-state
3471 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
3472 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3473 yes | no | yes | yes
3474 Arguments : none
3475
3476 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
3477 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
3478 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
3479 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
3480 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
3481
3482 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
3483 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
3484 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
3485 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
3486 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08003487 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
3488 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
3489 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3490
3491 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
3492 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
3493 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3494
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003495 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
3496 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
3497 checked in multiple backends.
3498
3499 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
3500 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
3501
3502 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
3503 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
3504 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
3505 one fails.
3506
3507 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
3508 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
3509 connections on all servers of the same backend.
3510
3511 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
3512 server's queue.
3513
3514 Example of a header received by the application server :
3515 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
3516 scur=13/22; qcur=0
3517
3518 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
3519
Willy Tarreaube1d34d2016-06-26 19:37:59 +02003520http-request { allow | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
3521 deny [deny_status <status>] |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003522 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003523 capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003524 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003525 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
3526 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003527 set-method <fmt> | set-path <fmt> | set-query <fmt> |
3528 set-uri <fmt> | set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003529 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3530 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3531 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannbb7e86a2014-09-03 18:29:47 +02003532 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003533 set-var(<var name>) <expr> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003534 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003535 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003536 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003537 silent-drop |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003538 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003539 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003540 Access control for Layer 7 requests
3541
3542 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3543 no | yes | yes | yes
3544
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003545 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3546 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3547 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3548 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3549 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003550
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003551 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3552 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
3553 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
3554
3555 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
Willy Tarreaube1d34d2016-06-26 19:37:59 +02003556 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code
3557 specified as an argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status
3558 codes is limited to those that can be overridden by the "errorfile"
3559 directive. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003560
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003561 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
3562 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
3563 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
3564 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
3565 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
3566 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
3567 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
3568 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
3569 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003570 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003571 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections. See
3572 also the "silent-drop" action below.
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003573
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003574 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
3575 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
3576 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
3577 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
3578 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
3579
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003580 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
3581 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
3582 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01003583 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
3584 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003585
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003586 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3587 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3588 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
3589 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
3590 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
3591 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
3592 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
3593 the resulting header from a previous rule.
3594
3595 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3596 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3597 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
Willy Tarreau85603282015-01-21 20:39:27 +01003598 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so
3599 it is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003600
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003601 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3602 <name>.
3603
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003604 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3605 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3606 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3607 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3608 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3609 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3610 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3611 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
3612
3613 Example:
3614
3615 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
3616
3617 applied to:
3618
3619 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3620
3621 outputs:
3622
3623 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3624
3625 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
3626
3627 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3628 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3629 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3630 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3631 header.
3632
3633 Example:
3634
3635 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
3636
3637 applied to:
3638
3639 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3640
3641 outputs:
3642
3643 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3644
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003645 - "set-method" rewrites the request method with the result of the
3646 evaluation of format string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons
3647 for having to do so as this is more likely to break something than to fix
3648 it.
3649
3650 - "set-path" rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of
3651 format string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a
3652 scheme and authority is found before the path, they are left intact as
3653 well. If the request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with
3654 the format. This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of
3655 a path for example. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3656
3657 Example :
3658 # prepend the host name before the path
3659 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
3660
3661 - "set-query" rewrites the request's query string which appears after the
3662 first question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format
3663 string <fmt>. The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the
3664 request doesn't contain a question mark and the new value is not empty,
3665 then one is added at the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If
3666 a question mark was present, it will never be removed even if the value
3667 is empty. This can be used to add or remove parameters from the query
3668 string. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3669
3670 Example :
3671 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
3672 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
3673
3674 - "set-uri" rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of
3675 format string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all
3676 replaced at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies,
3677 or to perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts
3678 between the path and the query string. See also "set-path" and
3679 "set-query".
3680
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003681 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3682 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3683 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3684 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3685 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3686 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3687 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3688 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3689
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003690 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3691 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3692 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3693 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3694 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3695 another equipment.
3696
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003697 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3698 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3699 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3700 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3701 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3702 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3703 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3704 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3705
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003706 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3707 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3708 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3709 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3710 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3711 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3712 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3713 admin privileges.
3714
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003715 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3716 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3717 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3718 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3719 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3720 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3721 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3722 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3723
3724 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3725 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3726 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3727 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3728 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3729 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3730
3731 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3732 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3733 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3734 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3735 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3736 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3737
3738 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3739 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3740 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3741 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3742 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3743 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3744 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3745 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3746 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3747
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003748 - capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] :
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02003749 captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts
3750 it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
3751 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear
3752 next to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in
3753 the logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules
3754 to feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
3755 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
3756 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
3757 request header" for more information.
3758
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003759 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store
3760 the captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful
3761 to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous
3762 directive "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
Baptiste Assmanne9544932015-11-03 23:31:35 +01003763 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the
3764 configuration to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003765
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02003766 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
3767 enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules
3768 do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Three sets of
3769 counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The first
3770 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
3771 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
3772 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
3773 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
3774 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
3775 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
3776 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
3777 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
3778
3779 These actions take one or two arguments :
3780 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
3781 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
3782 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
3783 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
3784
3785 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
3786 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
3787 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
3788 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
3789
3790 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
3791 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
3792 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
3793 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
3794 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
3795 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
3796 been started. As an exception, connection counters and request counters
3797 are systematically updated so that they reflect useful information.
3798
3799 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
3800 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
3801 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
3802 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
3803 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
3804
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003805 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
3806 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
3807 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
3808 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
3809 continues.
3810
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003811 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
3812 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
3813 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
3814 the actions evaluation continues.
3815
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003816 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr> :
3817 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
3818 inline.
3819
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003820 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
3821 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
3822 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
3823 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003824 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003825 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003826 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003827 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
3828 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003829 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003830 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003831 and '_'.
3832
3833 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
3834 followed by some converters.
3835
3836 Example:
3837
3838 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
3839
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02003840 - set-src <expr> :
3841 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
3842 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP,
3843 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
3844 source IP for privacy.
3845
3846 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
3847 followed by some converters.
3848
3849 Example:
3850
3851 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
3852 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
3853
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02003854 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
3855 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02003856
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02003857 - set-src-port <expr> :
3858 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
3859 expression.
3860
3861 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
3862 followed by some converters.
3863
3864 Example:
3865
3866 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
3867 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
3868
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02003869 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
3870 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
3871 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02003872
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02003873 - set-dst <expr> :
3874 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
3875 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination
3876 IP, but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
3877 the IP for privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
3878 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
3879
3880 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
3881 followed by some converters.
3882
3883 Example:
3884
3885 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
3886 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
3887
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02003888 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
3889 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
3890
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02003891 - set-dst-port <expr> :
3892 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
3893 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
3894 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
3895
3896 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
3897 followed by some converters.
3898
3899 Example:
3900
3901 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
3902 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
3903
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02003904 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
3905 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
3906 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
3907
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003908 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
3909 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way
3910 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
3911 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
3912 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
3913 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
3914 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
3915 down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact of using
3916 this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the client and
3917 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
3918 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
3919 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
3920 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
3921 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
3922 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
3923 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
3924
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003925 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
3926
3927 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
3928 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08003929 or "reqadd" rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are
3930 visible by almost all further ACL rules.
3931
3932 Using "reqadd"/"reqdel"/"reqrep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
3933 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
3934 delete headers, you can still use "reqdel". Also please use
3935 "http-request deny/allow/tarpit" instead of "reqdeny"/"reqpass"/"reqtarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003936
3937 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003938 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
3939 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
3940 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003941
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003942 http-request allow if nagios
3943 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
3944 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
3945 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003946
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003947 Example:
3948 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003949 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003950
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003951 Example:
3952 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
3953 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
Willy Tarreaufca42612015-08-27 17:15:05 +02003954 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003955 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
3956 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
3957 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
3958 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
3959 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
3960 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
3961
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003962 Example:
3963 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
3964 acl add path /addacl
3965 acl del path /delacl
3966
3967 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3968
3969 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
3970 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
3971
3972 Example:
3973 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3974 acl setmap path /setmap
3975 acl delmap path /delmap
3976
3977 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3978
3979 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
3980 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
3981
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02003982 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
3983 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003984
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003985http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02003986 capture <sample> id <id> | redirect <rule> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003987 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003988 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
3989 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02003990 set-status <status> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003991 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
3992 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3993 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3994 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003995 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003996 set-var(<var-name>) <expr> |
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08003997 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003998 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003999 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004000 silent-drop |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004001 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02004002 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004003 Access control for Layer 7 responses
4004
4005 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4006 no | yes | yes | yes
4007
4008 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4009 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4010 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4011 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4012 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4013 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4014
4015 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
4016 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
4017 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
4018 current section.
4019
4020 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
4021 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
4022 rules are evaluated.
4023
4024 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
4025 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
4026 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
4027 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
4028 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4029 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
4030 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
4031
4032 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
4033 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4034 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4035 external users.
4036
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004037 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
4038 <name>.
4039
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004040 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
4041 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
4042 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
4043 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
4044 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
4045 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
4046 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
4047 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
4048
4049 Example:
4050
4051 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4052
4053 applied to:
4054
4055 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4056
4057 outputs:
4058
4059 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4060
4061 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4062
4063 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
4064 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
4065 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
4066 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
4067 header.
4068
4069 Example:
4070
4071 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4072
4073 applied to:
4074
4075 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4076
4077 outputs:
4078
4079 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4080
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004081 - "set-status" replaces the response status code with <status> which must
4082 be an integer between 100 and 999. Note that the reason is automatically
4083 adapted to the new code.
4084
4085 Example:
4086
4087 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4088 http-response set-status 431
4089
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004090 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
4091 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
4092 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
4093 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
4094 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
4095 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
4096 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
4097 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
4098
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004099 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
4100 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
4101 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
4102 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
4103 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
4104 another equipment.
4105
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004106 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
4107 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
4108 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
4109 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
4110 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
4111 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
4112 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
4113 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4114
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004115 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
4116 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
4117 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
4118 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
4119 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
4120 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
4121 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
4122 admin privileges.
4123
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004124 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4125 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4126 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4127 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
4128 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4129 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4130 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
4131 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4132
4133 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4134 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4135 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4136 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4137 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
4138 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4139
4140 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4141 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4142 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4143 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4144 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4145 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4146
4147 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4148 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4149 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
4150 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
4151 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4152 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4153 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4154 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4155 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4156
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004157 - capture <sample> id <id> :
4158 captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and converts
4159 it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
4160 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
4161 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
4162 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
4163 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
4164 response header" for more information.
4165
4166 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing
4167 the string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
4168 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by
4169 a previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
4170 keyword.
Baptiste Assmanne9544932015-11-03 23:31:35 +01004171 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the
4172 configuration to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004173
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004174 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
4175 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
4176 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible
4177 on the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When
4178 a redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server
4179 are closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
4180
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004181 - set-var(<var-name>) expr:
4182 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4183 inline.
4184
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004185 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
4186 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
4187 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4188 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004189 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004190 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004191 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004192 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4193 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004194 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004195 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004196 and '_'.
4197
4198 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4199 followed by some converters.
4200
4201 Example:
4202
4203 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
4204
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004205 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
4206 enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer to
4207 "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
4208 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make
4209 use of samples in response (eg. res.*, status etc.) and samples below
4210 Layer 6 (eg. ssl related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is
4211 not supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
4212
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004213 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
4214 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
4215 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
4216 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
4217 continues.
4218
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004219 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
4220 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
4221 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
4222 the actions evaluation continues.
4223
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004224 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
4225 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way
4226 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
4227 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
4228 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
4229 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
4230 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
4231 down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact of using
4232 this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the client and
4233 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
4234 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
4235 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
4236 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
4237 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
4238 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
4239 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
4240
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004241 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
4242
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08004243 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004244 the HTTP processing, before "rspdel" or "rsprep" or "rspadd" rules. That way,
4245 headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004246 rules.
4247
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004248 Using "rspadd"/"rspdel"/"rsprep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4249 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4250 delete headers, you can still use "rspdel". Also please use
4251 "http-response deny" instead of "rspdeny".
4252
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004253 Example:
4254 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
4255
4256 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
4257
4258 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4259 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4260
4261 Example:
4262 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4263
4264 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
4265
4266 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4267 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
4268
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004269 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4270 ACL usage.
4271
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02004272
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004273http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
4274 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
4275
4276 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4277 yes | no | yes | yes
4278
4279 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
4280 belongs to the session that initiated it. The downside is that between the
4281 response and the next request, the connection remains idle and is not used.
4282 In many cases for performance reasons it is desirable to make it possible to
4283 reuse these idle connections to serve other requests from different sessions.
4284 This directive allows to tune this behaviour.
4285
4286 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
4287
4288 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This is
4289 the default choice. It may be enforced to cancel a different
4290 strategy inherited from a defaults section or for
4291 troubleshooting. For example, if an old bogus application
4292 considers that multiple requests over the same connection come
4293 from the same client and it is not possible to fix the
4294 application, it may be desirable to disable connection sharing
4295 in a single backend. An example of such an application could
4296 be an old haproxy using cookie insertion in tunnel mode and
4297 not checking any request past the first one.
4298
4299 - "safe" : this is the recommended strategy. The first request of a
4300 session is always sent over its own connection, and only
4301 subsequent requests may be dispatched over other existing
4302 connections. This ensures that in case the server closes the
4303 connection when the request is being sent, the browser can
4304 decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly equivalent to
4305 regular keep-alive, there should be no side effects.
4306
4307 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
4308 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
4309 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
4310 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
4311 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
4312 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
4313 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
4314 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
4315 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweights the
4316 downsides of rare connection failures.
4317
4318 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
4319 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
4320 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
4321 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
4322 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
4323 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
4324 consistent behaviour and will benefit from the connection
4325 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
4326 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
4327 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
4328 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
4329 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
4330
4331 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
4332 connection properties and compatiblities. Specifically :
4333 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependant value
4334 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared ;
4335
4336 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
4337 and are never shared ;
4338
4339 - connections receiving a status code 401 or 407 expect some authentication
4340 to be sent in return. Due to certain bogus authentication schemes (such
4341 as NTLM) relying on the connection, these connections are marked private
4342 and are never shared ;
4343
4344 No connection pool is involved, once a session dies, the last idle connection
4345 it was attached to is deleted at the same time. This ensures that connections
4346 may not last after all sessions are closed.
4347
4348 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
4349 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
4350 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
4351
4352 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
4353
4354
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004355http-send-name-header [<header>]
4356 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
4357
4358 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4359 yes | no | yes | yes
4360
4361 Arguments :
4362
4363 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
4364
4365 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
4366 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
4367 is added with the header string proved.
4368
4369 See also : "server"
4370
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004371id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02004372 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
4373 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4374 no | yes | yes | yes
4375 Arguments : none
4376
4377 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
4378 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
4379 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004380
4381
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004382ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4383 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
4384 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4385 no | yes | yes | yes
4386
4387 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
4388 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
4389 and running).
4390
4391 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4392 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
4393 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004394 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004395 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
4396
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004397 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4398 "unless" condition is met.
4399
4400 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
4401
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004402load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
4403 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
4404 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4405 yes | no | yes | yes
4406
4407 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
4408 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
4409 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
4410 reload occured. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
4411 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
4412 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
4413 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
4414 over the stats socket and redirect output.
4415
4416 The format of the file is versionned and is very specific. To understand it,
4417 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02004418 9.2 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004419
4420 Arguments:
4421 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
4422 named "server-state-file".
4423
4424 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
4425 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
4426 name is used as a file name.
4427
4428 none don't load any stat for this backend
4429
4430 Notes:
4431 - server's IP address is not updated unless DNS resolution is enabled on
4432 the server. It means that if a server IP address has been changed using
4433 the stat socket, this information won't be re-applied after reloading.
4434
4435 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
4436 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
4437
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004438 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004439
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004440 global
4441 stats socket /tmp/socket
4442 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004443
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004444 defaults
4445 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004446
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004447 backend bk
4448 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4449 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004450
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004451
4452 Then one can run :
4453
4454 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
4455
4456 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
4457
4458 1
4459 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4460 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4461 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4462
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004463 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004464
4465 global
4466 stats socket /tmp/socket
4467 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
4468
4469 defaults
4470 load-server-state-from-file local
4471
4472 backend bk
4473 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4474 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
4475
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004476
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004477 Then one can run :
4478
4479 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
4480
4481 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
4482
4483 1
4484 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4485 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4486 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4487
4488 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
4489 "show servers state"
4490
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004491
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004492log global
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004493log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004494no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004495 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
4496 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4497 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004498
4499 Prefix :
4500 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
4501 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
4502 prefix does not allow arguments.
4503
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004504 Arguments :
4505 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
4506 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
4507 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
4508 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
4509 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
4510 parameter.
4511
4512 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
4513 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
4514
4515 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
4516 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4517 standard syslog port).
4518
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01004519 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
4520 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4521 standard syslog port).
4522
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004523 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
4524 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
4525 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
4526 appropriately writeable).
4527
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004528 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4529 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004530
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004531 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
4532 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
4533 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
4534 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
4535 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
4536 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
4537 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
4538 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
4539 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
4540 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
4541 long captures or JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
4542
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004543 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
4544
4545 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
4546 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
4547 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
4548
4549 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
4550 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
4551 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004552 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
4553 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
4554 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
4555 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
4556 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004557
4558 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4559
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004560 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
4561 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
4562 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004563
4564 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
4565 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
4566 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
4567 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
4568
4569 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
4570 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004571
4572 Example :
4573 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004574 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
4575 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004576 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004577
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004578
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004579log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004580 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
4581 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4582 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004583
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004584 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
4585 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
4586 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
4587 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
4588 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004589
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02004590log-format-sd <string>
4591 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
4592 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4593 yes | yes | yes | no
4594
4595 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
4596 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
4597 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
4598 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
4599 which covers the log format string in depth.
4600
4601 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
4602 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
4603
4604 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
4605 log format to "rfc5424".
4606
4607 Example :
4608 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
4609
4610
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01004611log-tag <string>
4612 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
4613 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4614 yes | yes | yes | yes
4615
4616 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
4617 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
4618 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
4619 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
4620 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
4621 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
4622 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
4623 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
4624 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004625
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02004626max-keep-alive-queue <value>
4627 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
4628 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4629 yes | no | yes | yes
4630
4631 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
4632 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
4633 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
4634 servers.
4635
4636 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
4637 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
4638 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
4639 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
4640 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
4641 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
4642 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
4643 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
4644 picking a different server.
4645
4646 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
4647 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
4648 even if they have to be queued.
4649
4650 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
4651 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
4652
4653
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004654maxconn <conns>
4655 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
4656 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4657 yes | yes | yes | no
4658 Arguments :
4659 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
4660 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
4661 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
4662 closes.
4663
4664 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
4665 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
4666 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
4667 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01004668 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
4669 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
4670 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
4671 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004672
4673 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
4674 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
4675 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
4676
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02004677 By default, this value is set to 2000.
4678
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004679 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
4680
4681
4682mode { tcp|http|health }
4683 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
4684 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4685 yes | yes | yes | yes
4686 Arguments :
4687 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
4688 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
4689 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
4690 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
4691
4692 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
4693 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
4694 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
4695 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
4696 brings HAProxy most of its value.
4697
4698 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004699 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
4700 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
4701 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
4702 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
4703 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
4704 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
4705 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004706
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004707 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
4708 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
4709 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004710
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004711 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004712 defaults http_instances
4713 mode http
4714
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004715 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004716
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004717
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004718monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004719 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004720 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4721 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004722 Arguments :
4723 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
4724 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004725 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004726 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
4727 backend and its backup.
4728
4729 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
4730 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
4731 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
4732 servers in a list of backends.
4733
4734 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
4735 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
4736 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
4737 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
4738 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
4739 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
4740 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004741 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
4742 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004743
4744 Example:
4745 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004746 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004747 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
4748 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
4749 monitor-uri /site_alive
4750 monitor fail if site_dead
4751
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004752 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004753
4754
4755monitor-net <source>
4756 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
4757 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4758 yes | yes | yes | no
4759 Arguments :
4760 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
4761 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
4762 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
4763 followed by a mask.
4764
4765 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
4766 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004767 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004768 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
4769
4770 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
4771 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
4772 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
4773 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004774 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
4775 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
4776 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004777
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004778 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
4779 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
4780 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
4781 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
4782 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
4783 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004784
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01004785 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
4786 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004787
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004788 Example :
4789 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
4790 frontend www
4791 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
4792
4793 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
4794
4795
4796monitor-uri <uri>
4797 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
4798 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4799 yes | yes | yes | no
4800 Arguments :
4801 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
4802 health status instead of forwarding the request.
4803
4804 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
4805 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
4806 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
4807 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
4808 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
4809 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
4810 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
4811 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
4812
4813 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
4814 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
4815 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
4816 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
4817 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
4818 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
4819
4820 Example :
4821 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
4822 frontend www
4823 mode http
4824 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
4825
4826 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
4827
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004828
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004829option abortonclose
4830no option abortonclose
4831 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
4832 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4833 yes | no | yes | yes
4834 Arguments : none
4835
4836 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
4837 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
4838 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
4839 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004840 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004841 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
4842 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
4843 encountered while delivering the response.
4844
4845 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
4846 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
4847 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
4848 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
4849 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
4850 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004851 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004852 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004853 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004854 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
4855 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
4856 still not served and not pollute the servers.
4857
4858 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
4859 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
4860 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
4861 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
4862 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
4863 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
4864 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
4865 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004866 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004867
4868 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4869 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4870
4871 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
4872
4873
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004874option accept-invalid-http-request
4875no option accept-invalid-http-request
4876 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
4877 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4878 yes | yes | yes | no
4879 Arguments : none
4880
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004881 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004882 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
4883 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
4884 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
4885 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
4886 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
4887 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
4888 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01004889 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
4890 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
4891 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
4892 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
4893 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004894 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02004895 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
4896 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
4897 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004898
4899 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
4900 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
4901 been confirmed.
4902
4903 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
4904 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01004905 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
4906 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004907 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
4908
4909 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4910 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4911
4912 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
4913 stats socket.
4914
4915
4916option accept-invalid-http-response
4917no option accept-invalid-http-response
4918 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
4919 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4920 yes | no | yes | yes
4921 Arguments : none
4922
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004923 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004924 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
4925 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
4926 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
4927 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
4928 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
4929 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
4930 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004931 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
4932 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
4933 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004934
4935 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
4936 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
4937 been confirmed.
4938
4939 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
4940 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
4941 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
4942 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
4943
4944 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4945 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4946
4947 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
4948 stats socket.
4949
4950
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004951option allbackups
4952no option allbackups
4953 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
4954 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4955 yes | no | yes | yes
4956 Arguments : none
4957
4958 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
4959 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
4960 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
4961 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
4962 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
4963 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
4964 order between the backup servers anymore.
4965
4966 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
4967 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
4968
4969 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4970 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4971
4972
4973option checkcache
4974no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08004975 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004976 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4977 yes | no | yes | yes
4978 Arguments : none
4979
4980 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
4981 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004982 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004983 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
4984 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02004985 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004986
4987 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004988 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004989 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004990 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
4991 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004992 to the client are :
4993 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004994 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004995 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004996 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
4997 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
4998 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
4999 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
5000 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
5001 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
5002 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
5003 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
5004 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
5005 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
5006 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
5007
5008 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005009 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005010 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005011 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005012 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
5013
5014 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
5015 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005016 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005017 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
5018
5019 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5020 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5021
5022
5023option clitcpka
5024no option clitcpka
5025 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
5026 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5027 yes | yes | yes | no
5028 Arguments : none
5029
5030 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5031 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5032 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5033 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5034
5035 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5036 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5037 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5038 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5039
5040 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5041 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5042 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5043 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5044 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5045
5046 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5047
5048 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5049 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5050 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
5051
5052 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5053 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5054
5055 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
5056
5057
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005058option contstats
5059 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
5060 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5061 yes | yes | yes | no
5062 Arguments : none
5063
5064 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
5065 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
5066 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
5067 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
5068 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
5069 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
5070 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
5071
5072
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005073option dontlog-normal
5074no option dontlog-normal
5075 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
5076 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5077 yes | yes | yes | no
5078 Arguments : none
5079
5080 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
5081 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
5082 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
5083 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
5084 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
5085 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
5086 logged.
5087
5088 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
5089 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
5090 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
5091
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005092 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005093 logging.
5094
5095
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005096option dontlognull
5097no option dontlognull
5098 Enable or disable logging of null connections
5099 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5100 yes | yes | yes | no
5101 Arguments : none
5102
5103 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
5104 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
5105 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
5106 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
5107 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
5108 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005109 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
5110 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
5111 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005112
5113 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
5114 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
5115 would not be logged.
5116
5117 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5118 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5119
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005120 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
5121 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005122
5123
5124option forceclose
5125no option forceclose
5126 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
5127 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01005128 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005129 Arguments : none
5130
5131 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
5132 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
5133 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
5134 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
5135 global session times in the logs.
5136
5137 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01005138 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005139 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005140
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005141 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
5142 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
5143 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
5144
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005145 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
5146 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005147
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005148 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5149 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5150
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005151 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005152
5153
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005154option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005155 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
5156 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5157 yes | yes | yes | yes
5158 Arguments :
5159 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5160 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005161 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005162 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005163
5164 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
5165 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
5166 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
5167 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
5168 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
5169 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
5170 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005171 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
5172 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5173 possible that the client has already brought one.
5174
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005175 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005176 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005177 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
5178 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005179 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
5180 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005181
5182 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5183 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5184 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5185 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5186 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5187 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5188 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5189
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005190 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
5191 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
5192 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
5193 are under the control of the end-user.
5194
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005195 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005196 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5197 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005198 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
5199 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
5200 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005201
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005202 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005203 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
5204 frontend www
5205 mode http
5206 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
5207
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005208 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
5209 backend www
5210 mode http
5211 option forwardfor header X-Client
5212
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005213 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005214 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005215
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005216
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005217option http-buffer-request
5218no option http-buffer-request
5219 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
5220 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5221 yes | yes | yes | yes
5222 Arguments : none
5223
5224 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
5225 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
5226 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
5227 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
5228 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
5229 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
5230 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
5231 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
5232 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbufferred transmissions between
5233 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
5234 default.
5235
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01005236 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005237
5238
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005239option http-ignore-probes
5240no option http-ignore-probes
5241 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
5242 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5243 yes | yes | yes | no
5244 Arguments : none
5245
5246 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
5247 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
5248 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
5249 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
5250 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
5251 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
5252 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
5253 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
5254 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
5255 was received over a connection before it was closed ;
5256 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation ;
5257 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
5258
5259 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
5260 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
5261 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
5262 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
5263 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
5264 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
5265 are often the only way to detect them.
5266
5267 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5268 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5269
5270 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
5271
5272
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005273option http-keep-alive
5274no option http-keep-alive
5275 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
5276 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5277 yes | yes | yes | yes
5278 Arguments : none
5279
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005280 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5281 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5282 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
5283 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
5284 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5285 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
5286 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
5287
5288 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
5289 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005290 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
5291 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
5292 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
5293 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
5294 situations where this option may be useful :
5295
5296 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
5297 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
5298
5299 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
5300 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
5301
5302 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
5303 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
5304 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
5305 request.
5306
5307 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
5308 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005309 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
5310 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
5311 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005312
5313 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
5314 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
5315
5316 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5317 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5318 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5319 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
5320 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5321 not set.
5322
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005323 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
5324 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005325 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005326 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005327
5328 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005329 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
5330 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005331
5332
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005333option http-no-delay
5334no option http-no-delay
5335 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
5336 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5337 yes | yes | yes | yes
5338 Arguments : none
5339
5340 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
5341 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
5342 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
5343 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
5344 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
5345 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
5346 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
5347 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
5348 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
5349 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
5350 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
5351 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
5352 affected.
5353
5354 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
5355 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
5356 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
5357 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
5358 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
5359 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
5360 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
5361 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
5362 latency environments.
5363
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005364 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
5365
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005366
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005367option http-pretend-keepalive
5368no option http-pretend-keepalive
5369 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
5370 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5371 yes | yes | yes | yes
5372 Arguments : none
5373
5374 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
5375 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
5376 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
5377 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
5378 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
5379 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
5380 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
5381 consider the response complete.
5382
5383 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
5384 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
5385 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
5386 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
5387 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
5388 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
5389
5390 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
5391 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
5392 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
5393 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
5394 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
5395 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
5396 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
5397
5398 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5399 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005400 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02005401 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
5402 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005403
5404 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5405 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5406
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005407 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
5408 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005409
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005410
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005411option http-server-close
5412no option http-server-close
5413 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
5414 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5415 yes | yes | yes | yes
5416 Arguments : none
5417
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005418 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5419 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5420 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5421 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5422 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5423 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
5424 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
5425 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
5426 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
5427 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
5428 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
5429 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note
5430 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
5431 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
5432 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
5433 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005434
5435 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5436 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5437 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5438 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01005439 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5440 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005441
5442 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5443 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005444 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
5445 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005446 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
5447 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005448
5449 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5450 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5451
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005452 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005453 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5454 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005455
5456
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005457option http-tunnel
5458no option http-tunnel
5459 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
5460 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5461 yes | yes | yes | yes
5462 Arguments : none
5463
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005464 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5465 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5466 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5467 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5468 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5469 "option http-tunnel".
5470
5471 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005472 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005473 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
5474 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
5475 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
5476 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
5477 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
5478 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
5479 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005480
5481 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5482 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5483
5484 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
5485 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5486 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
5487
5488
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005489option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005490no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005491 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
5492 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5493 yes | yes | yes | no
5494 Arguments : none
5495
5496 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
5497 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
5498 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
5499 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
5500 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
5501 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
5502 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
5503
5504 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
5505 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005506 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
5507 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
5508 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005509
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01005510 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
5511 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
5512 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
5513 front of an existing proxy.
5514
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005515 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
5516
5517 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
5518 http-server-close".
5519
5520
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005521option httpchk
5522option httpchk <uri>
5523option httpchk <method> <uri>
5524option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
5525 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
5526 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5527 yes | no | yes | yes
5528 Arguments :
5529 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
5530 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
5531 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
5532 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
5533 ones.
5534
5535 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
5536 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5537 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5538
5539 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
5540 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
5541 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
5542 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
5543 after "\r\n" following the version string.
5544
5545 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
5546 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
5547 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
5548 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
5549 the lack of any response.
5550
5551 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
5552
5553 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
5554 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
5555 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
5556
5557 Examples :
5558 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
5559 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
5560 backend https_relay
5561 mode tcp
5562 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
5563 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
5564
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09005565 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
5566 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
5567 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005568
5569
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005570option httpclose
5571no option httpclose
5572 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
5573 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5574 yes | yes | yes | yes
5575 Arguments : none
5576
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005577 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5578 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5579 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5580 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005581 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005582 "option http-tunnel".
5583
5584 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
5585 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
5586 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
5587 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
5588 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
5589 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
5590 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
5591 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005592
5593 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005594 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01005595 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
5596 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
5597 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
5598 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
5599 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005600
5601 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5602 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005603 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
5604 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005605 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
5606 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005607
5608 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5609 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5610
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005611 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
5612 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005613
5614
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005615option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005616 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
5617 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5618 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005619 Arguments :
5620 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
5621 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
5622 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
5623 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
5624 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005625
5626 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5627 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5628 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
5629 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
5630 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
5631 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
5632 ports.
5633
5634 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5635
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01005636 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
5637 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005638
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005639 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005640
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005641
5642option http_proxy
5643no option http_proxy
5644 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
5645 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5646 yes | yes | yes | yes
5647 Arguments : none
5648
5649 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
5650 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
5651 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
5652 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
5653 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
5654
5655 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
5656 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005657 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
5658 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005659
5660 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5661 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5662
5663 Example :
5664 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
5665 backend direct_forward
5666 option httpclose
5667 option http_proxy
5668
5669 See also : "option httpclose"
5670
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005671
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005672option independent-streams
5673no option independent-streams
5674 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02005675 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5676 yes | yes | yes | yes
5677 Arguments : none
5678
5679 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
5680 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
5681 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
5682 receive data or not.
5683
5684 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
5685 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
5686 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
5687 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
5688 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
5689 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
5690 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
5691 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
5692 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
5693 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
5694 socket buffers.
5695
5696 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
5697 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
5698 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
5699 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
5700 slow lines, so use it with caution.
5701
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005702 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005703 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
5704 deprecated.
5705
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005706 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02005707
5708
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02005709option ldap-check
5710 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
5711 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5712 yes | no | yes | yes
5713 Arguments : none
5714
5715 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
5716 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
5717 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
5718 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
5719
5720 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
5721 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
5722
5723 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
5724 configure it.
5725
5726 Example :
5727 option ldap-check
5728
5729 See also : "option httpchk"
5730
5731
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005732option external-check
5733 Use external processes for server health checks
5734 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5735 yes | no | yes | yes
5736
5737 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
5738 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
5739 command".
5740
5741 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
5742
5743 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
5744
5745
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005746option log-health-checks
5747no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005748 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005749 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5750 yes | no | yes | yes
5751 Arguments : none
5752
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005753 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
5754 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
5755 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005756
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005757 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
5758 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
5759 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
5760 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
5761 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
5762
5763 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (eg: enable/disable on
5764 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005765
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005766 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
5767 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
5768 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005769
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005770
5771option log-separate-errors
5772no option log-separate-errors
5773 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
5774 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5775 yes | yes | yes | no
5776 Arguments : none
5777
5778 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
5779 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
5780 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
5781 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
5782 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
5783 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
5784 provides very important information.
5785
5786 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
5787 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
5788 error logs.
5789
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005790 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005791 logging.
5792
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005793
5794option logasap
5795no option logasap
5796 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
5797 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5798 yes | yes | yes | no
5799 Arguments : none
5800
5801 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
5802 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
5803 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
5804 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
5805 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
5806 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
5807 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005808 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005809 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
5810 bytes are expected to be transferred.
5811
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005812 Examples :
5813 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
5814 mode http
5815 option httplog
5816 option logasap
5817 log 192.168.2.200 local3
5818
5819 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
5820 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
5821 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
5822 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
5823
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005824 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005825 logging.
5826
5827
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02005828option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005829 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005830 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5831 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005832 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005833 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
5834 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02005835 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005836
5837 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
5838 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
5839 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
5840 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
5841 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
5842 in the MySQL table, like this :
5843
5844 USE mysql;
5845 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
5846 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
5847
5848 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
5849 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
5850 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
5851 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
5852 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
5853 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
5854 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
5855 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
5856 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
5857
5858 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
5859 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005860
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02005861 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005862
5863 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
5864 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
5865 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
5866 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02005867 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
5868 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005869
5870 See also: "option httpchk"
5871
5872
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005873option nolinger
5874no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005875 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005876 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5877 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005878 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005879
5880 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
5881 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
5882 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
5883 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
5884 connections.
5885
5886 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
5887 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
5888 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
5889 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
5890 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
5891 this too.
5892
5893 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
5894 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
5895 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
5896
5897 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
5898 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
5899 for servers.
5900
5901 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5902 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5903
5904
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005905option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
5906 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
5907 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5908 yes | yes | yes | yes
5909 Arguments :
5910 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5911 matching <network>
5912 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
5913 header name.
5914
5915 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
5916 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
5917 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
5918 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
5919 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
5920 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
5921 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
5922 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
5923 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5924 possible that the client has already brought one.
5925
5926 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
5927 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
5928 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
5929 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
5930 header and requires different one.
5931
5932 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5933 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5934 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5935 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5936 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5937 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5938 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5939
5940 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
5941 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5942 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
5943 both are defined.
5944
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005945 Examples :
5946 # Original Destination address
5947 frontend www
5948 mode http
5949 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
5950
5951 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
5952 backend www
5953 mode http
5954 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
5955
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005956 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
5957 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005958
5959
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005960option persist
5961no option persist
5962 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
5963 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5964 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005965 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005966
5967 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
5968 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
5969 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
5970 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
5971 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
5972 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
5973 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
5974 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
5975 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
5976 redirected to another valid server.
5977
5978 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5979 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5980
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005981 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005982
5983
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01005984option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
5985 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
5986 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5987 yes | no | yes | yes
5988 Arguments :
5989 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
5990 PostgreSQL server.
5991
5992 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
5993 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
5994 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
5995 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
5996
5997 See also: "option httpchk"
5998
5999
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006000option prefer-last-server
6001no option prefer-last-server
6002 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
6003 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6004 yes | no | yes | yes
6005 Arguments : none
6006
6007 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
6008 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
6009 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
6010 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
6011 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
6012 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
6013 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
6014 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
6015 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006016 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
6017 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
6018 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
6019 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
6020 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
6021 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
6022 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006023
6024 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6025 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6026
6027 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
6028
6029
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006030option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006031option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006032no option redispatch
6033 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6034 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6035 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006036 Arguments :
6037 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
6038 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
6039 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
6040 N indicate a redispath is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
6041 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
6042 historical behaviour of redispatching on the last retry, a
6043 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
6044 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
6045 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
6046
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006047
6048 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6049 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6050 be able to access the service anymore.
6051
6052 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
6053 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
6054
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006055 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006056 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6057 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006058
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006059 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
6060 "redisp" keywords.
6061
6062 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6063 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6064
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006065 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006066
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006067
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006068option redis-check
6069 Use redis health checks for server testing
6070 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6071 yes | no | yes | yes
6072 Arguments : none
6073
6074 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
6075 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6076 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
6077 find the "+PONG" response message.
6078
6079 Example :
6080 option redis-check
6081
6082 See also : "option httpchk"
6083
6084
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006085option smtpchk
6086option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
6087 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
6088 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6089 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006090 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006091 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
6092 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
6093 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
6094
6095 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
6096 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
6097 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
6098
6099 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
6100 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
6101 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
6102 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
6103 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
6104 dead server.
6105
6106 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
6107 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
6108 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
6109 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
6110
6111 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
6112 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
6113 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6114 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006115 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006116
6117 Example :
6118 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
6119
6120 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
6121
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006122
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02006123option socket-stats
6124no option socket-stats
6125
6126 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
6127 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6128 yes | yes | yes | no
6129
6130 Arguments : none
6131
6132
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006133option splice-auto
6134no option splice-auto
6135 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
6136 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6137 yes | yes | yes | yes
6138 Arguments : none
6139
6140 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
6141 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
6142 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
6143 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006144 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006145 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
6146 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
6147 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
6148 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6149
6150 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
6151 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
6152 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
6153 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
6154 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
6155 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
6156 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
6157 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
6158 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
6159 keyword.
6160
6161 Example :
6162 option splice-auto
6163
6164 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6165 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6166
6167 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
6168 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6169
6170
6171option splice-request
6172no option splice-request
6173 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
6174 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6175 yes | yes | yes | yes
6176 Arguments : none
6177
6178 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006179 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006180 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6181 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6182 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6183 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6184
6185 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6186
6187 Example :
6188 option splice-request
6189
6190 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6191 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6192
6193 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
6194 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6195
6196
6197option splice-response
6198no option splice-response
6199 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
6200 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6201 yes | yes | yes | yes
6202 Arguments : none
6203
6204 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006205 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006206 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6207 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6208 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6209 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6210
6211 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6212
6213 Example :
6214 option splice-response
6215
6216 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6217 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6218
6219 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
6220 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6221
6222
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006223option srvtcpka
6224no option srvtcpka
6225 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
6226 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6227 yes | no | yes | yes
6228 Arguments : none
6229
6230 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6231 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
6232 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
6233 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6234
6235 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6236 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6237 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6238 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6239
6240 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6241 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6242 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6243 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6244 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6245
6246 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6247
6248 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6249 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6250 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
6251
6252 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6253 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6254
6255 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
6256
6257
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006258option ssl-hello-chk
6259 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
6260 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6261 yes | no | yes | yes
6262 Arguments : none
6263
6264 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
6265 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
6266 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
6267 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
6268 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
6269 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
6270 hello message.
6271
6272 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
6273 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
6274 messages, which is appreciable.
6275
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006276 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
6277 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
6278 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006279
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006280 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
6281
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006282
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006283option tcp-check
6284 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
6285 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6286 yes | no | yes | yes
6287
6288 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
6289 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
6290
6291 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
6292 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
6293 attempt, which remains the default mode.
6294
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006295 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006296 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
6297 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
6298 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
6299 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
6300 only.
6301
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006302 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006303 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
6304 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
6305 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
6306 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
6307
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006308 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006309 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
6310 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006311 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006312 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
6313 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
6314 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
6315 the respective protocols.
6316 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
6317 analysed.
6318
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006319 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
6320 script.
6321
6322 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
6323 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
6324 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
6325 The "comment" is of course optional.
6326
6327
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006328 Examples :
6329 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
6330 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006331 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006332
6333 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
6334 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006335 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006336
6337 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
6338 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006339 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006340 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006341 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006342 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02006343 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006344 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006345 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
6346 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006347 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006348 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
6349 tcp-check expect string +OK
6350
6351 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
6352 (send many headers before analyzing)
6353 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006354 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006355 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
6356 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
6357 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
6358 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006359 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006360
6361
6362 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
6363
6364
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006365option tcp-smart-accept
6366no option tcp-smart-accept
6367 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
6368 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6369 yes | yes | yes | no
6370 Arguments : none
6371
6372 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
6373 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
6374 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
6375 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
6376 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
6377 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
6378
6379 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
6380 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
6381 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
6382 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
6383
6384 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
6385 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
6386 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
6387 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
6388
6389 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
6390 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
6391 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
6392
6393 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
6394 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
6395 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
6396
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02006397 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
6398
6399
6400option tcp-smart-connect
6401no option tcp-smart-connect
6402 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
6403 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6404 yes | no | yes | yes
6405 Arguments : none
6406
6407 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
6408 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
6409 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
6410 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
6411 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
6412
6413 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
6414 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
6415 complex.
6416
6417 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
6418 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
6419 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
6420
6421 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6422 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6423
6424 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
6425
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006426
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006427option tcpka
6428 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
6429 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6430 yes | yes | yes | yes
6431 Arguments : none
6432
6433 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6434 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
6435 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
6436 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6437
6438 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6439 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6440 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6441 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6442
6443 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6444 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6445 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6446 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6447 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6448
6449 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6450
6451 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
6452 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
6453 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
6454 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
6455 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
6456 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
6457 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
6458 backends.
6459
6460 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
6461
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006462
6463option tcplog
6464 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
6465 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6466 yes | yes | yes | yes
6467 Arguments : none
6468
6469 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6470 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6471 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
6472 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
6473 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
6474 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
6475 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
6476 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
6477
6478 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
6479
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006480 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006481
6482
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006483option transparent
6484no option transparent
6485 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6486 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006487 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006488 Arguments : none
6489
6490 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
6491 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6492 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6493 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6494 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6495 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6496 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6497 appropriate server.
6498
6499 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6500 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6501
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01006502 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006503 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006504
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006505
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006506external-check command <command>
6507 Executable to run when performing an external-check
6508 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6509 yes | no | yes | yes
6510
6511 Arguments :
6512 <command> is the external command to run
6513
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006514 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
6515
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006516 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006517
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006518 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
6519 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
6520 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
6521 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
6522 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
6523 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006524
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01006525 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
6526
6527 Environment variables :
6528 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
6529 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
6530
6531 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
6532
6533 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
6534
6535 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
6536 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
6537 for a UNIX socket).
6538
6539 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
6540
6541 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
6542
6543 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
6544
6545 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
6546
6547 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
6548
6549 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
6550 socket).
6551
6552 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
6553 the command may be set using "external-check path".
6554
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006555 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
6556 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
6557 failed.
6558
6559 Example :
6560 external-check command /bin/true
6561
6562 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
6563
6564
6565external-check path <path>
6566 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
6567 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6568 yes | no | yes | yes
6569
6570 Arguments :
6571 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
6572
6573 The default path is "".
6574
6575 Example :
6576 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
6577
6578 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
6579 "external-check command"
6580
6581
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006582persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02006583persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006584 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
6585 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6586 yes | no | yes | yes
6587 Arguments :
6588 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006589 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
6590 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006591
6592 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
6593 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
6594 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
6595 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
6596 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
6597 forwarded to this server.
6598
6599 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
6600 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
6601 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006602 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006603 a single "listen" section.
6604
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006605 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
6606 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
6607 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
6608
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006609 Example :
6610 listen tse-farm
6611 bind :3389
6612 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
6613 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6614 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
6615 # apply RDP cookie persistence
6616 persist rdp-cookie
6617 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006618 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006619 balance rdp-cookie
6620 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
6621 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
6622
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09006623 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
6624 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006625
6626
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006627rate-limit sessions <rate>
6628 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
6629 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6630 yes | yes | yes | no
6631 Arguments :
6632 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
6633 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
6634
6635 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
6636 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
6637 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
6638 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
6639 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
6640 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
6641
6642 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
6643 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
6644 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
6645 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
6646
6647 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
6648 listen smtp
6649 mode tcp
6650 bind :25
6651 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02006652 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006653
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02006654 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
6655 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
6656 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006657
6658 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
6659
6660
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006661redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6662redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6663redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006664 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
6665 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6666 no | yes | yes | yes
6667
6668 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01006669 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006670
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006671 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006672 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006673 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
6674 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
6675 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006676
6677 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
6678 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
6679 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
6680 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
6681 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006682 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
6683 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
6684 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
6685 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006686
6687 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
6688 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
6689 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
6690 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
6691 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
6692 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006693 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006694 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006695 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
6696 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
6697 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006698
6699 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01006700 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
6701 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
6702 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02006703 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01006704 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
6705 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
6706 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
6707 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006708
6709 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
6710 expected behaviour of a redirection :
6711
6712 - "drop-query"
6713 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
6714 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
6715 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
6716 with a location-type redirect.
6717
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01006718 - "append-slash"
6719 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
6720 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
6721 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
6722 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
6723
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006724 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
6725 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
6726 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
6727 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
6728 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
6729 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
6730 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
6731
6732 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
6733 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
6734 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
6735 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
6736 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
6737 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
6738 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006739
6740 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
6741 acl clear dst_port 80
6742 acl secure dst_port 8080
6743 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006744 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01006745 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006746 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
6747
6748 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01006749 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
6750 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
6751 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006752 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006753
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01006754 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
6755 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
6756 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
6757
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006758 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01006759 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006760
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006761 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02006762 http-request redirect code 301 location \
6763 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
6764 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006765
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006766 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006767
6768
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006769redisp (deprecated)
6770redispatch (deprecated)
6771 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6772 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6773 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006774 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006775
6776 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6777 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6778 be able to access the service anymore.
6779
6780 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
6781 redistribute them to a working server.
6782
6783 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
6784 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6785 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006786
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006787 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
6788 "option redispatch" instead.
6789
6790 See also : "option redispatch"
6791
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006792
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006793reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006794 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
6795 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6796 no | yes | yes | yes
6797 Arguments :
6798 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6799 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006800 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006801
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006802 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6803 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6804
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006805 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
6806 the last header of an HTTP request.
6807
6808 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6809 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6810 responses.
6811
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006812 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
6813 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
6814 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
6815
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006816 See also: "rspadd", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation,
6817 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006818
6819
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006820reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6821reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006822 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
6823 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6824 no | yes | yes | yes
6825 Arguments :
6826 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6827 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6828 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6829 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6830 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6831 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
6832 ignores case.
6833
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006834 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6835 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6836
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006837 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6838 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
6839 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
6840 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006841 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006842
6843 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6844 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6845
6846 Example :
6847 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
6848 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6849 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6850
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006851 See also: "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header
6852 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006853
6854
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006855reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6856reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006857 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
6858 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6859 no | yes | yes | yes
6860 Arguments :
6861 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6862 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6863 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6864 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6865 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
6866 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
6867
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006868 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6869 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6870
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006871 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
6872 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
6873 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
6874 next servers.
6875
6876 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6877 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6878 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
6879
6880 Example :
6881 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
6882 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
6883 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
6884
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006885 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", "http-request", section 6 about
6886 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006887
6888
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006889reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6890reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006891 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
6892 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6893 no | yes | yes | yes
6894 Arguments :
6895 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6896 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6897 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6898 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6899 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6900 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
6901 case.
6902
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006903 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6904 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6905
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006906 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6907 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
6908 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
6909 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006910 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006911
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006912 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006913 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006914 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006915
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006916 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6917 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6918
6919 Example :
6920 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
6921 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6922 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6923
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006924 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
6925 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006926
6927
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006928reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6929reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006930 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
6931 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6932 no | yes | yes | yes
6933 Arguments :
6934 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6935 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6936 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6937 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6938 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6939 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
6940 case.
6941
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006942 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6943 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6944
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006945 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6946 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
6947 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
6948 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
6949
6950 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6951 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6952
6953 Example :
6954 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
6955 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
6956 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6957 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6958
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006959 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
6960 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006961
6962
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006963reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6964reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006965 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
6966 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6967 no | yes | yes | yes
6968 Arguments :
6969 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6970 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6971 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6972 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6973 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
6974 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
6975
6976 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6977 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
6978 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
6979 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006980 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006981
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006982 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6983 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6984
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006985 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
6986 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
6987 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
6988
6989 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6990 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6991 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
6992 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
6993 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
6994
6995 Example :
6996 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006997 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006998 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
6999 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
7000
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007001 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", "http-request",
7002 section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007003
7004
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007005reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7006reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007007 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
7008 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7009 no | yes | yes | yes
7010 Arguments :
7011 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7012 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7013 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7014 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7015 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7016 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
7017 ignores case.
7018
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007019 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7020 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7021
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007022 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7023 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007024 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
7025 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
7026 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007027 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
7028 not set.
7029
7030 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
7031 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
7032 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
7033 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
7034 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
7035
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007036 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007037 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
7038 # block all others.
7039 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
7040 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
7041
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007042 # block bad guys
7043 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
7044 reqitarpit . if badguys
7045
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007046 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", "http-request", section 6
7047 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007048
7049
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007050retries <value>
7051 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
7052 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7053 yes | no | yes | yes
7054 Arguments :
7055 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
7056 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
7057 default value is 3.
7058
7059 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
7060 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
7061 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
7062
7063 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007064 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
7065 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007066
7067 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
7068 server even if a cookie references a different server.
7069
7070 See also : "option redispatch"
7071
7072
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007073rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007074 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
7075 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7076 no | yes | yes | yes
7077 Arguments :
7078 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7079 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007080 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007081
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007082 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7083 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7084
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007085 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7086 the last header of an HTTP response.
7087
7088 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7089 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7090 responses.
7091
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007092 See also: "rspdel" "reqadd", "http-response", section 6 about HTTP header
7093 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007094
7095
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007096rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7097rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007098 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
7099 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7100 no | yes | yes | yes
7101 Arguments :
7102 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7103 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7104 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7105 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7106 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7107 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
7108 ignores case.
7109
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007110 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7111 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7112
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007113 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
7114 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007115 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007116 client.
7117
7118 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7119 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7120 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7121
7122 Example :
7123 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02007124 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007125
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007126 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", "http-response", section 6 about
7127 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007128
7129
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007130rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7131rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007132 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
7133 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7134 no | yes | yes | yes
7135 Arguments :
7136 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7137 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7138 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7139 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7140 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7141 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
7142 ignores case.
7143
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007144 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7145 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7146
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007147 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7148 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
7149 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
7150 case-sensitive.
7151
7152 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007153 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
7154 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
7155 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007156
7157 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7158 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
7159
7160 Example :
7161 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
7162 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
7163
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007164 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", "http-response", section 6 about
7165 HTTP header manipulation and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007166
7167
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007168rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7169rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007170 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
7171 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7172 no | yes | yes | yes
7173 Arguments :
7174 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7175 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7176 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7177 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7178 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7179 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
7180 ignores case.
7181
7182 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7183 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7184 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7185 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007186 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007187
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007188 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7189 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7190
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007191 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
7192 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
7193 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
7194
7195 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7196 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7197 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7198 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
7199 are not case-sensitive.
7200
7201 Example :
7202 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
7203 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
7204
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007205 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", "http-response", section 6 about
7206 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007207
7208
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007209server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007210 Declare a server in a backend
7211 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7212 no | no | yes | yes
7213 Arguments :
7214 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02007215 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007216 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007217
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007218 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
7219 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
7220 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
7221 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02007222 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
7223 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
7224 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
7225 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
7226 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007227 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
7228 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
7229 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
7230 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
7231 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7232 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7233 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007234 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007235 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7236 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
7237 variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007238
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007239 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007240 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
7241 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
7242 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
7243 adding this value to the client's port.
7244
7245 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
7246 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007247 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007248
7249 Examples :
7250 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
7251 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007252 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007253 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
7254 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
7255 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007256
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02007257 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
7258 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
7259 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
7260 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
7261 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
7262
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007263 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
7264 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007265
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007266server-state-file-name [<file>]
7267 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
7268 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
7269 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
7270 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
7271 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
7272 global directive "server-state-file-base".
7273
7274 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
7275 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
7276
7277 global
7278 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
7279
7280 backend bk
7281 load-server-state-from-file
7282
7283 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
7284 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007285
7286source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007287source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007288source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007289 Set the source address for outgoing connections
7290 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7291 yes | no | yes | yes
7292 Arguments :
7293 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
7294 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007295
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007296 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007297 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
7298 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
7299 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
7300 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
7301 supported prefixes are :
7302 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7303 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7304 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007305 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02007306 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7307 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007308
7309 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
7310 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007311 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
7312 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
7313 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007314
7315 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
7316 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
7317 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
7318 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
7319 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
7320 <addr>.
7321
7322 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
7323 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
7324 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
7325 port.
7326
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007327 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
7328 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
7329 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
7330 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01007331 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007332 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
7333 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
7334 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
7335 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
7336 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
7337 HTTP header.
7338
7339 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
7340 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007341 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007342 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
7343 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
7344 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
7345 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
7346 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
7347 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
7348 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
7349
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007350 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
7351 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
7352 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
7353 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
7354 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
7355 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
7356
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007357 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
7358 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
7359 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
7360 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
7361
7362 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
7363 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
7364 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
7365 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
7366 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
7367 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
7368
7369 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
7370 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
7371 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
7372 there are two methods :
7373
7374 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
7375 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
7376 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
7377 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
7378 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
7379 of the client ranges may be used.
7380
7381 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
7382 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
7383 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
7384 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
7385 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
7386 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
7387 same session.
7388
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007389 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
7390 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
7391 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007392 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007393
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02007394 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
7395
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007396 Examples :
7397 backend private
7398 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
7399 source 192.168.1.200
7400
7401 backend transparent_ssl1
7402 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
7403 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7404
7405 backend transparent_ssl2
7406 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
7407 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
7408 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
7409
7410 backend transparent_ssl3
7411 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
7412 # is more conntrack-friendly.
7413 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7414
7415 backend transparent_smtp
7416 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
7417 # with Tproxy version 4.
7418 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
7419
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007420 backend transparent_http
7421 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
7422 # proxy.
7423 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
7424
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007425 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007426 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
7427
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007428
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007429srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7430 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7431 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7432 yes | no | yes | yes
7433 Arguments :
7434 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7435 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7436 as explained at the top of this document.
7437
7438 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7439 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7440 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7441 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7442 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7443 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7444 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7445
7446 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7447 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7448 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7449 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7450 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007451 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007452 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007453 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007454
7455 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7456 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7457 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7458 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7459 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7460 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7461
7462 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
7463 Please use "timeout server" instead.
7464
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007465 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
7466 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007467
7468
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007469stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
7470 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
7471 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007472 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007473
7474 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
7475 matched.
7476
7477 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
7478 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
7479
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007480 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7481 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7482 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7483
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01007484 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
7485 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
7486 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
7487 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007488
7489 Example :
7490 # statistics admin level only for localhost
7491 backend stats_localhost
7492 stats enable
7493 stats admin if LOCALHOST
7494
7495 Example :
7496 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
7497 backend stats_auth
7498 stats enable
7499 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
7500 stats admin if TRUE
7501
7502 Example :
7503 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
7504 userlist stats-auth
7505 group admin users admin
7506 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
7507 group readonly users haproxy
7508 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
7509
7510 backend stats_auth
7511 stats enable
7512 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
7513 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
7514 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
7515 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
7516
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007517 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
7518 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
7519 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007520
7521
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007522stats auth <user>:<passwd>
7523 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
7524 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007525 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007526 Arguments :
7527 <user> is a user name to grant access to
7528
7529 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
7530
7531 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
7532 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
7533 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
7534 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
7535 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
7536 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
7537
7538 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
7539 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
7540 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007541 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007542
7543 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
7544 report using "stats scope".
7545
7546 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7547 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7548 unobvious parameters.
7549
7550 Example :
7551 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7552 backend public_www
7553 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7554 stats enable
7555 stats hide-version
7556 stats scope .
7557 stats uri /admin?stats
7558 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7559 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7560 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7561
7562 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7563 backend private_monitoring
7564 stats enable
7565 stats uri /admin?stats
7566 stats refresh 5s
7567
7568 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
7569
7570
7571stats enable
7572 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
7573 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007574 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007575 Arguments : none
7576
7577 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
7578 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
7579 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
7580 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
7581 - stats auth : no authentication
7582 - stats scope : no restriction
7583
7584 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7585 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7586 unobvious parameters.
7587
7588 Example :
7589 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7590 backend public_www
7591 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7592 stats enable
7593 stats hide-version
7594 stats scope .
7595 stats uri /admin?stats
7596 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7597 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7598 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7599
7600 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7601 backend private_monitoring
7602 stats enable
7603 stats uri /admin?stats
7604 stats refresh 5s
7605
7606 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7607
7608
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007609stats hide-version
7610 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007611 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007612 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007613 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007614
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007615 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
7616 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
7617 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
7618 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
7619 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
7620 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007621
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02007622 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7623 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7624 unobvious parameters.
7625
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007626 Example :
7627 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7628 backend public_www
7629 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02007630 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007631 stats hide-version
7632 stats scope .
7633 stats uri /admin?stats
7634 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7635 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7636 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007637
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007638 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7639 backend private_monitoring
7640 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007641 stats uri /admin?stats
7642 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01007643
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007644 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007645
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01007646
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02007647stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
7648 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7649 Access control for statistics
7650
7651 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7652 no | no | yes | yes
7653
7654 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
7655 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
7656 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
7657 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
7658 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
7659 should be asked to enter a username and password.
7660
7661 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
7662 instance.
7663
7664 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
7665 about ACL usage.
7666
7667
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007668stats realm <realm>
7669 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
7670 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007671 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007672 Arguments :
7673 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
7674 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
7675 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
7676
7677 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
7678 using a backslash ('\').
7679
7680 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
7681 only related to authentication.
7682
7683 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7684 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7685 unobvious parameters.
7686
7687 Example :
7688 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7689 backend public_www
7690 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7691 stats enable
7692 stats hide-version
7693 stats scope .
7694 stats uri /admin?stats
7695 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7696 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7697 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7698
7699 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7700 backend private_monitoring
7701 stats enable
7702 stats uri /admin?stats
7703 stats refresh 5s
7704
7705 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
7706
7707
7708stats refresh <delay>
7709 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
7710 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007711 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007712 Arguments :
7713 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
7714 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
7715 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
7716 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
7717 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
7718 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
7719
7720 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
7721 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
7722 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
7723 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
7724
7725 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7726 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7727 unobvious parameters.
7728
7729 Example :
7730 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7731 backend public_www
7732 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7733 stats enable
7734 stats hide-version
7735 stats scope .
7736 stats uri /admin?stats
7737 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7738 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7739 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7740
7741 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7742 backend private_monitoring
7743 stats enable
7744 stats uri /admin?stats
7745 stats refresh 5s
7746
7747 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7748
7749
7750stats scope { <name> | "." }
7751 Enable statistics and limit access scope
7752 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007753 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007754 Arguments :
7755 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
7756 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
7757 section in which the statement appears.
7758
7759 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
7760 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
7761 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
7762 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
7763 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
7764 exists.
7765
7766 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7767 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7768 unobvious parameters.
7769
7770 Example :
7771 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7772 backend public_www
7773 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7774 stats enable
7775 stats hide-version
7776 stats scope .
7777 stats uri /admin?stats
7778 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7779 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7780 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7781
7782 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7783 backend private_monitoring
7784 stats enable
7785 stats uri /admin?stats
7786 stats refresh 5s
7787
7788 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7789
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007790
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007791stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007792 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
7793 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007794 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007795
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007796 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007797 description from global section is automatically used instead.
7798
7799 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
7800 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
7801
7802 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7803 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007804 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007805
7806 Example :
7807 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7808 backend private_monitoring
7809 stats enable
7810 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
7811 stats uri /admin?stats
7812 stats refresh 5s
7813
7814 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
7815 global section.
7816
7817
7818stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007819 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
7820 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7821 yes | yes | yes | yes
7822 Arguments : none
7823
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007824 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007825 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
7826 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
7827 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
7828 - IP (socket, server)
7829 - cookie (backend, server)
7830
7831 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7832 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007833 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007834
7835 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
7836
7837
7838stats show-node [ <name> ]
7839 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
7840 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007841 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007842 Arguments:
7843 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
7844 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
7845
7846 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
7847 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007848 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007849
7850 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7851 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7852 unobvious parameters.
7853
7854 Example:
7855 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7856 backend private_monitoring
7857 stats enable
7858 stats show-node Europe-1
7859 stats uri /admin?stats
7860 stats refresh 5s
7861
7862 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
7863 section.
7864
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007865
7866stats uri <prefix>
7867 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
7868 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007869 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007870 Arguments :
7871 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
7872 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
7873 query string.
7874
7875 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
7876 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
7877 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
7878 possible to reach it in the application.
7879
7880 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007881 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007882 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
7883 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
7884 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
7885 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
7886
7887 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
7888 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
7889 an address or a port to statistics only.
7890
7891 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7892 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7893 unobvious parameters.
7894
7895 Example :
7896 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7897 backend public_www
7898 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7899 stats enable
7900 stats hide-version
7901 stats scope .
7902 stats uri /admin?stats
7903 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7904 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7905 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7906
7907 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7908 backend private_monitoring
7909 stats enable
7910 stats uri /admin?stats
7911 stats refresh 5s
7912
7913 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
7914
7915
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007916stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
7917 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007918 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007919 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007920
7921 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007922 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007923 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
7924 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
7925 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
7926
7927 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7928 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7929 the "stick-table" statement.
7930
7931 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
7932 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
7933 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
7934 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
7935 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
7936
7937 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7938 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
7939 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
7940 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
7941 transformation rules.
7942
7943 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7944 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7945 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7946 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7947 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7948 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7949 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7950
7951 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
7952 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
7953 ACL based conditions.
7954
7955 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
7956 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
7957 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
7958 matches can be used as fallbacks.
7959
7960 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
7961 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
7962 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
7963 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
7964
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007965 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7966 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7967 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7968
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007969 Example :
7970 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
7971 # last 30 minutes
7972 backend pop
7973 mode tcp
7974 balance roundrobin
7975 stick store-request src
7976 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
7977 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
7978 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
7979
7980 backend smtp
7981 mode tcp
7982 balance roundrobin
7983 stick match src table pop
7984 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
7985 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
7986
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007987 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007988 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007989
7990
7991stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7992 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
7993 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7994 no | no | yes | yes
7995
7996 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
7997 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
7998 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
7999 for writing more maintainable configurations.
8000
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008001 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8002 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8003 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8004
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008005 Examples :
8006 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01008007 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008008
8009 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
8010 stick match src table pop if !localhost
8011 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
8012
8013
8014 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
8015 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
8016 backend http
8017 mode http
8018 balance roundrobin
8019 stick on src table https
8020 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
8021 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
8022 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
8023
8024 backend https
8025 mode tcp
8026 balance roundrobin
8027 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8028 stick on src
8029 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8030 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8031
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008032 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008033
8034
8035stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8036 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
8037 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8038 no | no | yes | yes
8039
8040 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008041 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008042 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
8043 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
8044 server is selected.
8045
8046 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8047 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8048 the "stick-table" statement.
8049
8050 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8051 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8052 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
8053 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
8054 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
8055 address.
8056
8057 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8058 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
8059 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
8060 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
8061 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
8062 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
8063 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
8064 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
8065 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
8066 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
8067
8068 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8069 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8070 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8071 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8072 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8073 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8074 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8075
8076 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
8077 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8078 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
8079 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8080
8081 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
8082 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8083 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8084 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8085 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8086 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008087 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
8088 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8089 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8090 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8091 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8092 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008093
8094 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
8095 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
8096 the request.
8097
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008098 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8099 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8100 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8101
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008102 Example :
8103 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8104 # last 30 minutes
8105 backend pop
8106 mode tcp
8107 balance roundrobin
8108 stick store-request src
8109 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8110 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8111 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8112
8113 backend smtp
8114 mode tcp
8115 balance roundrobin
8116 stick match src table pop
8117 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8118 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8119
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008120 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008121 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008122
8123
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008124stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008125 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
8126 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08008127 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008128 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008129 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008130
8131 Arguments :
8132 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
8133 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
8134 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8135 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8136
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008137 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
8138 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
8139 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8140 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8141
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008142 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
8143 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
8144 instance.
8145
8146 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
8147 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
8148 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
8149 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
8150 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
8151 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008152 to 32 characters.
8153
8154 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
8155 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
8156 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008157 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008158 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
8159 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008160
8161 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008162 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
8163 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008164 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
8165 increase.
8166
8167 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008168 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
8169 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
8170 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008171
8172 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
8173 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
8174 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
8175 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
8176 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
8177 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
8178 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
8179 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
8180 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
8181 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
8182 parameter (see below).
8183
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008184 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
8185 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
8186 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
8187 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
8188 soft restart.
8189
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02008190 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
8191 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008192
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008193 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
8194 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
8195 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
8196 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
8197 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008198 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008199 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
8200 if not expiration delay is specified.
8201
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008202 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
8203 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
8204 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
8205 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008206 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
8207 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
8208 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
8209 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
8210 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
8211 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
8212 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
8213 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
8214 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
8215 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
8216 types and their arguments.
8217
8218 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
8219 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
8220 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
8221 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
8222
8223 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
8224 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
8225 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
8226 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
8227
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008228 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
8229 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
8230 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
8231 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
8232 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
8233 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
8234
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008235 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8236 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
8237 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
8238 they were received.
8239
8240 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8241 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
8242 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
8243 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
8244 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
8245
8246 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8247 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8248 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8249 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
8250 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8251
8252 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8253 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
8254 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
8255
8256 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8257 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8258 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8259 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
8260 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8261
8262 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8263 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
8264 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
8265 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
8266 the client side.
8267
8268 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8269 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8270 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8271 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
8272 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
8273 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
8274 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
8275
8276 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8277 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
8278 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
8279 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
8280 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
8281 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
8282 (eg: vulnerability scan).
8283
8284 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8285 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8286 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8287 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
8288 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
8289 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8290
8291 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
8292 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
8293 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
8294 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
8295
8296 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8297 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8298 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8299 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8300 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8301 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
8302 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
8303 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
8304 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
8305 recommended for better fairness.
8306
8307 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
8308 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
8309 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
8310 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
8311
8312 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
8313 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8314 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8315 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8316 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8317 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
8318 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
8319 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
8320 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
8321 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008322
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008323 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
8324 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008325 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
8326 reference it.
8327
8328 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
8329 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01008330 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
8331 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
8332 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008333
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008334 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
8335 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
8336 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
8337 something that can be ignored.
8338
8339 Example:
8340 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
8341 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
8342 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
8343 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
8344
8345 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01008346 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008347
8348
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008349stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01008350 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008351 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8352 no | no | yes | yes
8353
8354 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008355 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008356 describes what elements of the response or connection will
8357 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
8358 server is selected.
8359
8360 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8361 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8362 the "stick-table" statement.
8363
8364 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8365 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8366 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
8367 when the response is a SSL server hello.
8368
8369 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8370 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
8371 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
8372 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
8373 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
8374 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008375 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008376 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
8377 rules.
8378
8379 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8380 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8381 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8382 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8383 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8384 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8385 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8386
8387 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
8388 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8389 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
8390 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8391
8392 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
8393 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8394 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8395 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8396 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8397 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008398 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
8399 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8400 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8401 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8402 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8403 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
8404 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
8405 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
8406 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008407
8408 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
8409
8410 Example :
8411 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
8412 backend https
8413 mode tcp
8414 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008415 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008416 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008417
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008418 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
8419 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
8420
8421 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
8422 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8423 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
8424
8425 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
8426 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008427
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008428 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
8429 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
8430 # at offset 44.
8431
8432 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
8433 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
8434
8435 # Learn on response if server hello.
8436 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008437
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008438 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8439 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8440
8441 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
8442 extraction.
8443
8444
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008445tcp-check connect [params*]
8446 Opens a new connection
8447 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8448 no | no | yes | yes
8449
8450 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
8451 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
8452 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
8453
8454 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
8455 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
8456 of the sequence.
8457
8458 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
8459 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
8460 do.
8461
8462 Parameters :
8463 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
8464 use the TCP connection.
8465
8466 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
8467 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
8468 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
8469
8470 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
8471
8472 ssl opens a ciphered connection
8473
8474 Examples:
8475 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
8476 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
8477 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
8478 option tcp-check
8479 tcp-check connect
8480 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8481 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8482 tcp-check send \r\n
8483 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8484 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
8485 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8486 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8487 tcp-check send \r\n
8488 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8489 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
8490
8491 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
8492 option tcp-check
8493 tcp-check connect port 110
8494 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8495 tcp-check connect port 143
8496 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8497 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
8498
8499 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
8500
8501
8502tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
8503 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
8504 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8505 no | no | yes | yes
8506
8507 Arguments :
8508 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
8509 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
8510 binary.
8511 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
8512 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
8513 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
8514
8515 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
8516 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
8517 with the usual backslash ('\').
8518 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
8519 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
8520 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
8521 used upper or lower case.
8522
8523
8524 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
8525
8526 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
8527 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8528 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
8529 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8530 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
8531 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
8532 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
8533 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
8534
8535 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
8536 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8537 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
8538 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8539 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
8540 expression.
8541
8542 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
8543 in the response buffer. A health check response will
8544 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
8545 this exact hexadecimal string.
8546 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
8547
8548 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
8549 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
8550 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
8551 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
8552 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
8553 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
8554 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
8555 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
8556 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
8557 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
8558 the null character.
8559
8560 Examples :
8561 # perform a POP check
8562 option tcp-check
8563 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8564
8565 # perform an IMAP check
8566 option tcp-check
8567 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8568
8569 # look for the redis master server
8570 option tcp-check
8571 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02008572 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008573 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8574 tcp-check expect string role:master
8575 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
8576 tcp-check expect string +OK
8577
8578
8579 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
8580 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
8581
8582
8583tcp-check send <data>
8584 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8585 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8586 no | no | yes | yes
8587
8588 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8589 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
8590
8591 Examples :
8592 # look for the redis master server
8593 option tcp-check
8594 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8595 tcp-check expect string role:master
8596
8597 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
8598 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
8599
8600
8601tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
8602 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
8603 tcp health check
8604 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8605 no | no | yes | yes
8606
8607 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8608 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
8609 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
8610 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
8611 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
8612 hexadecimal string.
8613 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
8614
8615 Examples :
8616 # redis check in binary
8617 option tcp-check
8618 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
8619 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
8620
8621
8622 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
8623 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
8624
8625
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008626tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8627 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02008628 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8629 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008630 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02008631 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
8632 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02008633
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008634 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008635
8636 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
8637 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008638 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
8639 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
8640 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
8641 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
8642 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
8643 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008644
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008645 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
8646 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
8647 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
8648 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008649
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02008650 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008651 - accept :
8652 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8653 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8654 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008655
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008656 - reject :
8657 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8658 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8659 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
8660 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
8661 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
8662 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
8663 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
8664 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
8665 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
8666 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
8667 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
8668 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008669
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008670 - expect-proxy layer4 :
8671 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
8672 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
8673 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
8674 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
8675 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
8676 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
8677 hosts.
8678
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01008679 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
8680 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
8681 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
8682 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
8683 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
8684 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
8685 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
8686 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
8687
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008688 - capture <sample> len <length> :
8689 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
8690 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
8691 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
8692 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
8693 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
8694 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
8695 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
8696 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02008697 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
8698 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008699
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008700 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008701 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02008702 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. 3 sets
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008703 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008704 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
8705 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008706 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008707 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
8708 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
8709 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
8710 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
8711 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008712
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008713 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008714 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008715 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008716 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
8717 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
8718 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
8719 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008720
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008721 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
8722 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
8723 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
8724 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008725
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008726 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
8727 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
8728 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
8729 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
8730 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008731 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
8732 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
8733 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
8734 layer7 information is extracted.
8735
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008736 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
8737 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
8738 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
8739 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
8740 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008741
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02008742 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
8743 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
8744 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
8745 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
8746
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02008747 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
8748 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
8749 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
8750 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
8751 continues.
8752
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02008753 - set-src <expr> :
8754 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
8755 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
8756 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
8757 set-src"
8758
8759 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8760 followed by some converters.
8761
8762 Example:
8763
8764 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
8765
8766 When set-src is successful, the source port is set to 0.
8767
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02008768 - set-src-port <expr> :
8769 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
8770 expression.
8771
8772 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8773 followed by some converters.
8774
8775 Example:
8776
8777 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
8778
8779 Be careful to use "set-src-port" after "set-src", because "set-src" sets
8780 the source port to 0.
8781
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02008782 - set-dst <expr> :
8783 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
8784 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
8785 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
8786 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
8787 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
8788
8789 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8790 followed by some converters.
8791
8792 Example:
8793
8794 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
8795 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
8796
8797 - set-dst-port <expr> :
8798 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
8799 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
8800 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
8801
8802
8803 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8804 followed by some converters.
8805
8806 Example:
8807
8808 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
8809
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02008810 - "silent-drop" :
8811 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
8812 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way that tries
8813 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
8814 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
8815 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
8816 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
8817 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
8818 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact
8819 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the
8820 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
8821 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
8822 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
8823 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
8824 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
8825 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
8826 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
8827
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008828 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
8829 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
8830 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008831
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008832 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
8833 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
8834 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008835
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008836 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008837 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008838 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008839
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008840 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
8841 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
8842 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008843
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008844 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008845 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
8846 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008847
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008848 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
8849
8850 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
8851
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008852 See section 7 about ACL usage.
8853
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008854 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008855
8856
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008857tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8858 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008859 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02008860 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008861 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02008862 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
8863 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008864
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008865 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008866
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008867 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
8868 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
8869 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
8870 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
8871 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008872
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008873 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
8874 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
8875 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
8876 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008877 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
8878 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
8879 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
8880 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
8881 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
8882 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008883 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008884 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008885
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008886 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
8887 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
8888 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
8889 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008890
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02008891 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008892 - accept : the request is accepted
8893 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
8894 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008895 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02008896 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +02008897 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008898 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02008899 - silent-drop
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008900
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008901 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
8902 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008903
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008904 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
8905 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
8906 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
8907 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
8908 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
8909 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008910
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008911 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008912 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
8913 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008914
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008915 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02008916 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
8917 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
8918 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
8919 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008920 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
8921 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
8922 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008923
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008924 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02008925 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
8926 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
8927 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008928
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008929 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
8930 declared inline.
8931
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01008932 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
8933 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
8934 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
8935 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008936 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01008937 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008938 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01008939 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
8940 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008941 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01008942 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
8943 and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008944
8945 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8946 followed by some converters.
8947
8948 Example:
8949
8950 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
8951
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008952 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008953 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
8954 # and reject everything else.
8955 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
8956 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02008957 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008958 tcp-request content reject
8959
8960 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008961 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
8962 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
8963 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008964 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008965
8966 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
8967 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
8968 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008969 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008970 tcp-request content reject
8971
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008972 Example:
8973 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
8974 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02008975 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008976
8977 Example:
8978 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
8979 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02008980 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008981
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008982 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
8983 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
8984
8985 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008986 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008987 # protecting all our sites
8988 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008989 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
8990 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008991 ...
8992 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
8993
8994 backend http_dynamic
8995 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008996 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008997 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008998 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
8999 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
9000 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009001 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009002
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009003 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009004
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009005 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009006
9007
9008tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
9009 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
9010 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009011 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009012 Arguments :
9013 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9014 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9015 as explained at the top of this document.
9016
9017 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
9018 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
9019 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
9020 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
9021 data for at most the specified amount of time.
9022
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009023 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
9024 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
9025 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
9026 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
9027
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009028 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
9029 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009030 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009031 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01009032 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
9033 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
9034 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
9035 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009036
9037 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
9038 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
9039 it pass through unaffected.
9040
9041 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
9042 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
9043 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009044 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009045 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
9046 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02009047 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
9048 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
9049 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009050
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009051 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009052 "timeout client".
9053
9054
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009055tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9056 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
9057 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9058 no | no | yes | yes
9059 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009060 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9061 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009062
9063 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9064
9065 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
9066 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9067 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009068 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
9069 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009070
9071 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
9072
9073 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9074 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9075 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9076 inserted.
9077
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009078 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009079 - accept :
9080 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9081 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9082 the rules evaluation.
9083
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009084 - close :
9085 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
9086 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
9087 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
9088 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
9089 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
9090 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009091 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009092 protocols.
9093
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009094 - reject :
9095 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9096 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009097 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009098
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009099 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
9100 Sets a variable.
9101
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009102 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9103 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9104 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
9105 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
9106
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009107 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
9108 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9109 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9110 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9111 continues.
9112
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009113 - "silent-drop" :
9114 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
9115 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way that tries
9116 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9117 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9118 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9119 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9120 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
9121 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact
9122 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the
9123 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9124 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
9125 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
9126 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9127 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9128 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9129 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9130
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009131 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9132 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9133 for changing the default action to a reject.
9134
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009135 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
9136 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
9137 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
9138 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009139 period.
9140
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009141 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
9142 declared inline.
9143
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009144 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9145 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
9146 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9147 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009148 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009149 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009150 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009151 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9152 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009153 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009154 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
9155 and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009156
9157 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9158 followed by some converters.
9159
9160 Example:
9161
9162 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
9163
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009164 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9165
9166 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
9167
9168
9169tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
9170 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
9171 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9172 no | no | yes | yes
9173 Arguments :
9174 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9175 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9176 as explained at the top of this document.
9177
9178 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
9179
9180
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009181timeout check <timeout>
9182 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
9183 established.
9184
9185 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9186 yes | no | yes | yes
9187 Arguments:
9188 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9189 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9190 as explained at the top of this document.
9191
9192 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
9193 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
9194 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
9195 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01009196 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
9197 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
9198 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009199
9200 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
9201 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
9202
9203 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
9204 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009205 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009206
9207 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9208 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9209 forget about it.
9210
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009211 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
9212 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009213
9214
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009215timeout client <timeout>
9216timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9217 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
9218 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9219 yes | yes | yes | no
9220 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009221 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009222 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9223 as explained at the top of this document.
9224
9225 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
9226 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
9227 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +01009228 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
9229 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
9230 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
9231 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009232 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
9233 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
9234 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009235 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009236 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009237 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
9238 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009239 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
9240 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009241
9242 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
9243 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9244 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9245 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9246 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
9247 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9248
9249 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
9250 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
9251 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9252
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +01009253 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel",
9254 "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009255
9256
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009257timeout client-fin <timeout>
9258 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
9259 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9260 yes | yes | yes | no
9261 Arguments :
9262 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9263 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9264 as explained at the top of this document.
9265
9266 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
9267 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
9268 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
9269 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
9270 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
9271 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
9272 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
9273 down in one direction.
9274
9275 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
9276 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
9277 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
9278
9279 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
9280
9281
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009282timeout connect <timeout>
9283timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9284 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
9285 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9286 yes | no | yes | yes
9287 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009288 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009289 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9290 as explained at the top of this document.
9291
9292 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009293 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009294 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009295 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009296 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
9297 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009298
9299 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9300 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9301 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9302 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9303 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
9304 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9305
9306 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
9307 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
9308 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9309
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009310 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
9311 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009312
9313
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009314timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
9315 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
9316 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9317 yes | yes | yes | yes
9318 Arguments :
9319 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9320 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9321 as explained at the top of this document.
9322
9323 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
9324 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
9325 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
9326 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
9327 once the request has started to present itself.
9328
9329 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
9330 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
9331 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
9332 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
9333 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
9334
9335 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
9336 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
9337 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
9338 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
9339
9340 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
9341 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
9342 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
9343 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
9344 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02009345 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009346
9347 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
9348 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
9349 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
9350 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
9351
9352 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
9353
9354
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009355timeout http-request <timeout>
9356 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
9357 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02009358 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009359 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009360 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009361 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9362 as explained at the top of this document.
9363
9364 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
9365 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
9366 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
9367 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
9368 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
9369 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
9370 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02009371 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
9372 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
9373 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
9374 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
9375 standard, well-documented behaviour, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009376 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
9377 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009378
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01009379 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
9380 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
9381 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
9382 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
9383 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009384 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009385
9386 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
9387 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
9388 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
9389 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
9390 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
9391
9392 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02009393 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
9394 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
9395 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009396
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009397 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01009398 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009399
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009400
9401timeout queue <timeout>
9402 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
9403 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9404 yes | no | yes | yes
9405 Arguments :
9406 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9407 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9408 as explained at the top of this document.
9409
9410 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
9411 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
9412 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
9413 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
9414 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
9415
9416 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
9417 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
9418 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
9419 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
9420
9421 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
9422
9423
9424timeout server <timeout>
9425timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9426 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
9427 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9428 yes | no | yes | yes
9429 Arguments :
9430 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9431 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9432 as explained at the top of this document.
9433
9434 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
9435 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
9436 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
9437 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
9438 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
9439 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
9440 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
9441
9442 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9443 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9444 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
9445 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
9446 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009447 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009448 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009449 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
9450 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
9451 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
9452 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009453
9454 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9455 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9456 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9457 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9458 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
9459 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9460
9461 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
9462 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
9463 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9464
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009465 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009466
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009467
9468timeout server-fin <timeout>
9469 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
9470 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9471 yes | no | yes | yes
9472 Arguments :
9473 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9474 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9475 as explained at the top of this document.
9476
9477 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
9478 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
9479 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
9480 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
9481 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
9482 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
9483 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
9484 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
9485 situations, it should not be needed.
9486
9487 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9488 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
9489 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
9490
9491 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
9492
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009493
9494timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009495 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009496 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9497 yes | yes | yes | yes
9498 Arguments :
9499 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
9500 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9501 as explained at the top of this document.
9502
9503 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
9504 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
9505 defines how long it will be maintained open.
9506
9507 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9508 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9509 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
9510 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009511 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009512
9513 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
9514
9515
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009516timeout tunnel <timeout>
9517 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
9518 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9519 yes | no | yes | yes
9520 Arguments :
9521 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9522 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9523 as explained at the top of this document.
9524
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009525 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009526 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
9527 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
9528 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
9529 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
9530 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
9531 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
9532 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
9533 specified.
9534
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009535 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
9536 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
9537 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
9538 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
9539 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
9540 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
9541 state.
9542
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009543 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9544 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9545 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
9546 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
9547 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
9548
9549 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9550 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9551 forget about it.
9552
9553 Example :
9554 defaults http
9555 option http-server-close
9556 timeout connect 5s
9557 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009558 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009559 timeout server 30s
9560 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
9561
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009562 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009563
9564
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009565transparent (deprecated)
9566 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9567 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009568 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009569 Arguments : none
9570
9571 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
9572 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9573 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9574 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9575 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9576 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9577 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9578 appropriate server.
9579
9580 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
9581
9582 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9583 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9584
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009585 See also: "option transparent"
9586
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009587unique-id-format <string>
9588 Generate a unique ID for each request.
9589 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9590 yes | yes | yes | no
9591 Arguments :
9592 <string> is a log-format string.
9593
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009594 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
9595 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
9596 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
9597 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009598
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009599 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
9600 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
9601 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
9602 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
9603 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
9604 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
9605 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
9606 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009607
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009608 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
9609 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009610
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009611 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009612
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05009613 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009614
9615 will generate:
9616
9617 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
9618
9619 See also: "unique-id-header"
9620
9621unique-id-header <name>
9622 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
9623 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9624 yes | yes | yes | no
9625 Arguments :
9626 <name> is the name of the header.
9627
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009628 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
9629 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009630
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009631 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009632
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05009633 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009634 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
9635
9636 will generate:
9637
9638 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
9639
9640 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009641
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02009642use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02009643 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009644 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9645 no | yes | yes | no
9646 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01009647 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
9648 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009649
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02009650 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
9651 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009652
9653 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
9654 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
9655 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02009656 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
9657 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
9658 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
9659 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009660
9661 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
9662 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
9663 assign the backend.
9664
9665 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
9666 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
9667 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
9668 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
9669 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
9670 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
9671
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02009672 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009673 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02009674 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
9675 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
9676 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
9677
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01009678 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
9679 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
9680 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
9681 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
9682 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
9683 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
9684 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
9685 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
9686 cannot be forced from the request.
9687
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009688 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01009689 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
9690 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
9691
9692 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
9693 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009694
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009695
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009696use-server <server> if <condition>
9697use-server <server> unless <condition>
9698 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
9699 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9700 no | no | yes | yes
9701 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009702 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009703
9704 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
9705
9706 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
9707 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
9708 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
9709
9710 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
9711 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
9712 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
9713 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
9714 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
9715 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
9716 matches will assign the server.
9717
9718 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
9719 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
9720 with the next rules until one matches.
9721
9722 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
9723 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
9724 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
9725 according to other persistence mechanisms.
9726
9727 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
9728 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
9729 stripped.
9730
9731 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
9732 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
9733 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
9734 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
9735
9736 Example :
9737 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
9738 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
9739 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
9740 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
9741 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
9742 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
9743 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
9744 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
9745 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
9746
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009747 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009748
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009749
97505. Bind and Server options
9751--------------------------
9752
9753The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
9754depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
9755settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
9756written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
9757described in this section.
9758
9759
97605.1. Bind options
9761-----------------
9762
9763The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
9764as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
9765no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
9766parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
9767while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
9768provided immediately after the setting name.
9769
9770The currently supported settings are the following ones.
9771
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +01009772accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
9773 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
9774 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
9775 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
9776 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
9777 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
9778 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
9779 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
9780 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
9781 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01009782 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
9783 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
9784 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +01009785
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009786accept-proxy
9787 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +02009788 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
9789 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009790 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
9791 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
9792 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
9793 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
9794 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
9795 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
9796 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009797 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
9798 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009799
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02009800alpn <protocols>
9801 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
9802 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
9803 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
9804 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
9805 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
9806 initial NPN extension.
9807
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009808backlog <backlog>
9809 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
9810 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
9811
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02009812ecdhe <named curve>
9813 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +01009814 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
9815 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02009816
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02009817ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02009818 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9819 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
9820 client's certificate.
9821
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02009822ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
9823 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
9824 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
9825 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
9826 error is ignored.
9827
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02009828ca-sign-file <cafile>
9829 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9830 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
9831 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
9832 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
9833 'generate-certificates' for details.
9834
9835ca-sign-passphrase <passphrase>
9836 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
9837 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
9838 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
9839 'generate-certificates' for details.
9840
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009841ciphers <ciphers>
9842 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
9843 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009844 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009845 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
9846 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
9847
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02009848crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02009849 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9850 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
9851 to verify client's certificate.
9852
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009853crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009854 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9855 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
9856 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
9857 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
9858 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
9859 file.
9860
9861 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
9862 are loaded.
9863
9864 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +01009865 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +01009866 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
9867 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
9868 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
9869 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
9870 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
9871 instead of the first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches
9872 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009873
9874 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
9875 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
9876 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
9877 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +01009878 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
9879 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009880
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02009881 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009882
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009883 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
9884 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +08009885 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009886 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
9887 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
9888 clients).
9889
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +02009890 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
9891 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
9892 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
9893 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
9894 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
9895 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
9896 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
9897 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
9898 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
9899 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
9900 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
9901 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
9902 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
9903
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +01009904 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
9905 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
9906 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
9907 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
9908 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
9909
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -05009910 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
9911 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
9912 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
9913 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -05009914
9915 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
9916 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
9917 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
9918 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
9919 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
9920 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
9921 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
9922 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
9923 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
9924
9925 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
9926
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -05009927 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -05009928 a cert bundle.
9929
9930 Haproxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
9931 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
9932 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
9933 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
9934 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
9935 provide multi-cert support.
9936
9937 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
9938
9939 Filename | CN | SAN
9940 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
9941 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -05009942 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -05009943 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
9944 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
9945
9946 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
9947 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
9948 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
9949 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
9950 suites.
9951
9952 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
9953 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
9954
9955 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
9956 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
9957 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
9958
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02009959crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009960 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
9961 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009962 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009963 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02009964
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009965crt-list <file>
9966 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02009967 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
9968 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009969
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02009970 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009971
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02009972 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
9973 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
9974 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
9975 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
9976 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
9977 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
9978 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
9979 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009980
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -05009981 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +02009982 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
9983 all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -05009984
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009985defer-accept
9986 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
9987 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
9988 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
9989 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
9990 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
9991 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
9992 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
9993 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
9994 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
9995 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
9996 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
9997
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009998force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009999 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010000 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010001 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
10002 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010003
10004force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010005 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010006 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
10007 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010008
10009force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010010 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010011 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
10012 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010013
10014force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010015 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010016 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
10017 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010018
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010019generate-certificates
10020 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10021 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
10022 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
10023 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
10024 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
10025 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
10026 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
10027 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
10028 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
10029 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
10030 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
10031
10032 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
10033 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
10034 increases the HAProxy's memroy footprint to reduce latency when the same
10035 certificate is used many times.
10036
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010037gid <gid>
10038 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
10039 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10040 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
10041 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
10042 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10043
10044group <group>
10045 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
10046 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
10047 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
10048 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
10049 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10050
10051id <id>
10052 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
10053 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
10054 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
10055 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
10056
10057interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010010058 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
10059 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
10060 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
10061 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
10062 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
10063 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
10064 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010065
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020010066level <level>
10067 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
10068 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
10069 sockets. <level> can be one of :
10070 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
10071 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
10072 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
10073 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
10074 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
10075 counters).
10076 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
10077 all counters).
10078
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010079maxconn <maxconn>
10080 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
10081 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
10082 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
10083 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
10084 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
10085 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
10086 eat all memory.
10087
10088mode <mode>
10089 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
10090 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
10091 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
10092 UNIX sockets.
10093
10094mss <maxseg>
10095 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
10096 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
10097 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
10098 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
10099 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
10100 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
10101 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
10102 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
10103 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
10104 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
10105 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
10106
10107name <name>
10108 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
10109 page.
10110
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020010111namespace <name>
10112 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
10113 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
10114 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
10115 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
10116
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010117nice <nice>
10118 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
10119 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
10120 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
10121 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
10122 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
10123 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
10124 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
10125 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
10126 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
10127 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
10128 one for an RDP socket.
10129
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010130no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010131 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010132 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010133 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010134 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
10135 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "force-tls*",
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010136 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010137
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020010138no-tls-tickets
10139 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10140 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
10141 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010142 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
10143 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020010144
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010145no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010146 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010147 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010148 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010149 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
10150 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
10151 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010152
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010153no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010154 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010155 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010156 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010157 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
10158 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
10159 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010160
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010161no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010162 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010163 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010164 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010165 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
10166 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
10167 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010168
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020010169npn <protocols>
10170 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
10171 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
10172 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
10173 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010174 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
10175 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020010176
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020010177process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ]
10178 This restricts the list of processes on which this listener is allowed to
10179 run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do not match.
10180 If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection between the
10181 two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run on any
10182 remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either run on
10183 the first process of the listener if a single process was specified, or on
10184 all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. For the unlikely
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +020010185 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated. The
10186 main purpose of this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have
10187 one different socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind
10188 lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so
10189 that the system can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues
10190 and allow a smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and
10191 above is known for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020010192
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010193ssl
10194 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010195 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010196 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
10197 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
10198 to deciphered contents.
10199
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010010200strict-sni
10201 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
10202 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
10203 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
10204 See the "crt" option for more information.
10205
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010206tcp-ut <delay>
10207 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instanciated from this
10208 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
10209 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
10210 receiving an acknoledgement for the configured delay. This is especially
10211 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
10212 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
10213 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
10214 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
10215 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
10216 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
10217 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
10218
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010219tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010010220 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010221 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
10222 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
10223 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
10224 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
10225 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
10226 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
10227 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020010228 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
10229 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
10230 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010231
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010010232tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
10233 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
10234 bytes long, encoded with base64 (ex. openssl rand -base64 48). Number of keys
10235 is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO build option (default 3) and at least as
10236 many keys need to be present in the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be
10237 used for decryption and the penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy
10238 key rotation by just appending new key to the file and reloading the process.
10239 Keys must be periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy
10240 is compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
10241 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
10242 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
10243
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010244transparent
10245 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
10246 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
10247 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
10248 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
10249 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
10250 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
10251 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
10252 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
10253 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
10254 so check for support with your vendor.
10255
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010256v4v6
10257 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
10258 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
10259 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
10260 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010261 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010262
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010010263v6only
10264 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
10265 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
10266 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010267 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
10268 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010010269
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010270uid <uid>
10271 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
10272 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10273 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
10274 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
10275 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10276
10277user <user>
10278 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
10279 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10280 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
10281 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
10282 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10283
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010284verify [none|optional|required]
10285 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
10286 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
10287 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
10288 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
10289 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010290 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
10291 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
10292 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
10293 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010294
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200102955.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010010296------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010297
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010010298The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
10299which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
10300arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
10301settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
10302after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
10303Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
10304address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010305
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010306 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010010307 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010308
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010309The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010310
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020010311addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010312 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010010313 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
10314 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
10315 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
10316 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
10317 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010318
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010319 Supported in default-server: No
10320
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010321agent-check
10322 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010323 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
10324 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
10325 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
10326 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010327
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010328 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010329 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020010330 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
10331 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
10332 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010333
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020010334 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values in
10335 this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
10336 connections advertised needs to be multipled by the number of load balancers
10337 and different backends that use this health check to get the total number
10338 of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
10339
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010340 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10341 READY mode, thus cancelling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010342
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010343 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10344 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
10345 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010346
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010347 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10348 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
10349 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010350
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010351 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
10352 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
10353 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
10354 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
10355 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
10356 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (eg: missing process,
10357 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010358
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010359 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
10360 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010361
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010362 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
10363 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
10364 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
10365 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
10366 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
10367 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
10368 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
10369 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
10370 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010371
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090010372 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
10373 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010374 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
10375 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
10376 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010010377 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090010378
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010379 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
10380 parameter.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010381
10382 Supported in default-server: No
10383
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070010384agent-send <string>
10385 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
10386 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
10387 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
10388 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
10389 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
10390
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010391agent-inter <delay>
10392 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
10393 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
10394
10395 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
10396 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
10397 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
10398 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
10399 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
10400 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
10401 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
10402 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
10403 of backends use the same servers.
10404
10405 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
10406
10407 Supported in default-server: Yes
10408
10409agent-port <port>
10410 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
10411
10412 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
10413
10414 Supported in default-server: Yes
10415
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010416backup
10417 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
10418 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
10419 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
10420 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
10421 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
10422 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010423
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010424 Supported in default-server: No
10425
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010426ca-file <cafile>
10427 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10428 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10429 server's certificate.
10430
10431 Supported in default-server: No
10432
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010433check
10434 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010010435 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
10436 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
10437 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
10438 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
10439 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
10440 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
10441 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090010442 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
10443 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
10444 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010445
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010446 Supported in default-server: No
10447
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020010448check-send-proxy
10449 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
10450 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
10451 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
10452 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
10453 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
10454 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
10455 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
10456
10457 Supported in default-server: No
10458
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010459check-ssl
10460 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
10461 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
10462 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
10463 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010464 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010465 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
10466 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
10467 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
10468 See the "ssl" option for more information.
10469
10470 Supported in default-server: No
10471
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010472ciphers <ciphers>
10473 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010474 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010475 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
10476 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
10477 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
10478 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
10479 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
10480 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
10481
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010482 Supported in default-server: No
10483
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010484cookie <value>
10485 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
10486 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
10487 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
10488 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
10489 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
10490 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
10491 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
10492
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010493 Supported in default-server: No
10494
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010495crl-file <crlfile>
10496 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10497 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10498 to verify server's certificate.
10499
10500 Supported in default-server: No
10501
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020010502crt <cert>
10503 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10504 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
10505 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
10506 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
10507 certificate request.
10508
10509 Supported in default-server: No
10510
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020010511disabled
10512 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
10513 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
10514 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
10515 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
10516 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
10517
10518 Supported in default-server: No
10519
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010520error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010521 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
10522 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
10523 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010524
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010525 Supported in default-server: Yes
10526
10527 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010528
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010529fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010530 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
10531 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
10532 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
10533
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010534 Supported in default-server: Yes
10535
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010536force-sslv3
10537 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
10538 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010539 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
10540 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010541
10542 Supported in default-server: No
10543
10544force-tlsv10
10545 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010546 the server. This option is also available on global statement
10547 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010548
10549 Supported in default-server: No
10550
10551force-tlsv11
10552 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010553 the server. This option is also available on global statement
10554 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010555
10556 Supported in default-server: No
10557
10558force-tlsv12
10559 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010560 the server. This option is also available on global statement
10561 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010562
10563 Supported in default-server: No
10564
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010565id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020010566 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
10567 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
10568 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010569
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010570 Supported in default-server: No
10571
10572inter <delay>
10573fastinter <delay>
10574downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010575 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
10576 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
10577 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
10578 between checks depending on the server state :
10579
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020010580 Server state | Interval used
10581 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
10582 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
10583 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
10584 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
10585 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
10586 or yet unchecked. |
10587 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
10588 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
10589 | "inter" otherwise.
10590 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010591
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010592 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
10593 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
10594 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
10595 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010596 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
10597 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
10598 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
10599 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
10600 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010601
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010602 Supported in default-server: Yes
10603
10604maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010605 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
10606 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
10607 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
10608 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
10609 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
10610 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
10611 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
10612 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
10613
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010614 Supported in default-server: Yes
10615
10616maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010617 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
10618 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
10619 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
10620 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
10621 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
10622 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
10623 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
10624
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010625 Supported in default-server: Yes
10626
10627minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010628 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
10629 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
10630 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
10631 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
10632 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
10633 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010634 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010635 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010636
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010637 Supported in default-server: Yes
10638
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020010639namespace <name>
10640 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
10641 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
10642 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
10643 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
10644
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010010645no-ssl-reuse
10646 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
10647 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
10648 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
10649 and for paranoid users.
10650
10651 Supported in default-server: No
10652
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010653no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010654 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
10655 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010656 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010657
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010658 Supported in default-server: No
10659
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020010660no-tls-tickets
10661 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10662 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
10663 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010664 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
10665 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020010666
10667 Supported in default-server: No
10668
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010669no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010670 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010671 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
10672 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010673 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
10674 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
10675 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010676
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010677 Supported in default-server: No
10678
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010679no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010680 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010681 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
10682 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010683 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
10684 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
10685 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010686
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010687 Supported in default-server: No
10688
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010689no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010690 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010691 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
10692 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010693 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
10694 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
10695 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010696
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010697 Supported in default-server: No
10698
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090010699non-stick
10700 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
10701 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
10702 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
10703
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010704 Supported in default-server: No
10705
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010706observe <mode>
10707 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
10708 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
10709 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
10710 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
10711 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
10712 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010010713 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010714
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010715 Supported in default-server: No
10716
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010717 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
10718
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010719on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010720 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
10721 Currently, four modes are available:
10722 - fastinter: force fastinter
10723 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
10724 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
10725 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
10726 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
10727
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010728 Supported in default-server: Yes
10729
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010730 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
10731
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090010732on-marked-down <action>
10733 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
10734 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070010735 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
10736 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
10737 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
10738 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
10739 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
10740 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
10741 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
10742 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090010743
10744 Actions are disabled by default
10745
10746 Supported in default-server: Yes
10747
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070010748on-marked-up <action>
10749 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
10750 Currently one action is available:
10751 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
10752 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
10753 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
10754 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
10755 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
10756 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
10757 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
10758 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
10759
10760 Actions are disabled by default
10761
10762 Supported in default-server: Yes
10763
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010764port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010765 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
10766 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
10767 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
10768 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
10769 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
10770 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
10771
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010772 Supported in default-server: Yes
10773
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010774redir <prefix>
10775 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
10776 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
10777 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
10778 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
10779 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
10780 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
10781 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
10782 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010783 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010784 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
10785 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
10786 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
10787 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
10788 loop between the client and HAProxy!
10789
10790 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
10791
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010792 Supported in default-server: No
10793
10794rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010795 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
10796 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
10797 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
10798
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010799 Supported in default-server: Yes
10800
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010801resolve-prefer <family>
10802 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
10803 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
10804 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
10805 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
10806
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020010807 Default value: ipv6
10808
10809 Supported in default-server: Yes
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010810
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020010811 Example:
10812
10813 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010814
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010010815resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
10816 This options prioritize th choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
10817 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
10818 avalailibility service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
10819 differents datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
10820 this patch permitsto prefers a local datacenter. If none address matchs the
10821 configured network, another address is selected.
10822
10823 Supported in default-server: Yes
10824
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020010825 Example:
10826
10827 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010010828
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010829resolvers <id>
10830 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
10831 hostname.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020010832 In order to be operational, DNS resolution requires that health check is
10833 enabled on the server. Actually, health checks triggers the DNS resolution.
10834 You must precise one 'resolvers' parameter on each server line where DNS
10835 resolution is required.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010836
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020010837 Supported in default-server: No
10838
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020010839 Example:
10840
10841 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010842
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020010843 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010844
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010010845send-proxy
10846 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
10847 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
10848 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
10849 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010850 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
10851 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
10852 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
10853 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
10854 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
10855 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
10856 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
10857 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
10858 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
10859 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
10860 See also the "accept-proxy" and "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind"
10861 keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010010862
10863 Supported in default-server: No
10864
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040010865send-proxy-v2
10866 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
10867 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
10868 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
10869 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
10870 whatever the upper layer protocol. This setting must not be used if the
10871 server isn't aware of this version of the protocol. See also the "send-proxy"
10872 option of the "bind" keyword.
10873
10874 Supported in default-server: No
10875
10876send-proxy-v2-ssl
10877 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
10878 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
10879 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
10880 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
10881 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
10882 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
10883 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
10884 See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
10885
10886 Supported in default-server: No
10887
10888send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
10889 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
10890 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
10891 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
10892 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
10893 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
10894 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
10895 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
10896 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
10897 protocol. See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
10898
10899 Supported in default-server: No
10900
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010901slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010902 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
10903 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
10904 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
10905 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
10906 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
10907 parameters :
10908
10909 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
10910 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
10911
10912 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
10913 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
10914 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
10915 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
10916
10917 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
10918 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
10919 seen as failed.
10920
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010921 Supported in default-server: Yes
10922
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020010923sni <expression>
10924 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
10925 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
10926 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
10927 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
10928 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense.
10929
10930 Supported in default-server: no
10931
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010932source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010933source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010934source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010935 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
10936 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
10937 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
10938 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
10939
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010940 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
10941 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
10942 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
10943 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
10944 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
10945 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
10946 server.
10947
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000010948 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
10949 specifying the source address without port(s).
10950
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010951 Supported in default-server: No
10952
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010953ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020010954 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
10955 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
10956 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
10957 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
10958 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
10959 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010960 See the "check-ssl" option to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010961
10962 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010963
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020010964tcp-ut <delay>
10965 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
10966 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
10967 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
10968 acknoledgement for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
10969 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
10970 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
10971 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
10972 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
10973 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
10974 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
10975 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
10976 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
10977 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
10978
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010979track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020010980 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
10981 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
10982 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
10983 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010984 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
10985
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010986 Supported in default-server: No
10987
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010988verify [none|required]
10989 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010010990 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
10991 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
10992 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
10993 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020010994 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
10995 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
10996 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010997
10998 Supported in default-server: No
10999
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070011000verifyhost <hostname>
11001 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
11002 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
11003 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
11004 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
11005 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
11006 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
11007
11008 Supported in default-server: No
11009
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011010weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011011 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
11012 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
11013 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020011014 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
11015 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
11016 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
11017 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
11018 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
11019 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011020
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011021 Supported in default-server: Yes
11022
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011023
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200110245.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
11025-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011026
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011027HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
11028using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
11029configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011030This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
11031can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
11032workload.
11033This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
11034resolution at run time.
11035Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
11036carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
11037
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011038Bear in mind that DNS resolution is triggered by health checks. This makes
11039health checks mandatory to allow DNS resolution.
11040
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011041
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200110425.3.1. Global overview
11043----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011044
11045As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
11046different steps of the process life:
11047
11048 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
11049 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
11050 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
11051
11052 2. at run time, when HAProxy gets prepared to run a health check on a server,
11053 it verifies if the current name resolution is still considered as valid.
11054 If not, it processes a new resolution, in parallel of the health check.
11055
11056A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
11057 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
11058 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
11059 resolution to know this new IP.
11060
11061A few things important to notice:
11062 - all the name servers are queried in the mean time. HAProxy will process the
11063 first valid response.
11064
11065 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
11066 servers return an error.
11067
11068
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200110695.3.2. The resolvers section
11070----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011071
11072This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
11073HAProxy.
11074There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can contain
11075many name servers.
11076
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011077When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
11078uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
11079is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
11080answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
11081
11082When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
11083used by HAProxy to decide what type of behavior to apply.
11084
11085Two types of behavior can be applied:
11086 1. stop DNS resolution
11087 2. replay the DNS query with a new query type
11088 In such case, the following types are applied in this exact order:
11089 1. ANY query type
11090 2. query type corresponding to family pointed by resolve-prefer
11091 server's parameter
11092 3. remaining family type
11093
11094HAProxy stops DNS resolution when the following errors occur:
11095 - invalid DNS response packet
11096 - wrong name in the query section of the response
11097 - NX domain
11098 - Query refused by server
11099 - CNAME not pointing to an IP address
11100
11101HAProxy tries a new query type when the following errors occur:
11102 - no Answer records in the response
11103 - DNS response truncated
11104 - Error in DNS response
11105 - No expected DNS records found in the response
11106 - name server timeout
11107
11108For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section:
11109 - first response is valid and is applied directly, second response is ignored
11110 - first response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
11111 applied;
11112 - first response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
11113 HAProxy replays the query with a new type;
11114 - first response is truncated and second one is a NX Domain, then HAProxy
11115 stops resolution.
11116
11117
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011118resolvers <resolvers id>
11119 Creates a new name server list labelled <resolvers id>
11120
11121A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
11122
11123nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
11124 DNS server description:
11125 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
11126 <ip> : IP address of the server
11127 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
11128
11129hold <status> <period>
11130 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
11131 on last resolution <status>
11132 <status> : last name resolution status. Only "valid" is accepted for now.
11133 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
11134 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
11135 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
11136
11137 Default value is 10s for "valid".
11138
11139 Note: since the name resolution is triggered by the health checks, a new
11140 resolution is triggered after <period> modulo the <inter> parameter of
11141 the healch check.
11142
11143resolve_retries <nb>
11144 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
11145 giving up.
11146 Default value: 3
11147
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011148 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
11149 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
11150 type.
11151
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011152timeout <event> <time>
11153 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
11154 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
11155 events available are:
11156 - retry: time between two DNS queries, when no response have
11157 been received.
11158 Default value: 1s
11159 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
11160 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
11161
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011162 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011163
11164 resolvers mydns
11165 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
11166 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
11167 resolve_retries 3
11168 timeout retry 1s
11169 hold valid 10s
11170
11171
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200111726. HTTP header manipulation
11173---------------------------
11174
11175In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
11176response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
11177request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
11178which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010011179against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011180
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010011181If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
11182to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
11183but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
11184HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
11185stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
11186because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
11187a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
11188still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020011189
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011190This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
11191in section 4.2 :
11192
11193 - reqadd <string>
11194 - reqallow <search>
11195 - reqiallow <search>
11196 - reqdel <search>
11197 - reqidel <search>
11198 - reqdeny <search>
11199 - reqideny <search>
11200 - reqpass <search>
11201 - reqipass <search>
11202 - reqrep <search> <replace>
11203 - reqirep <search> <replace>
11204 - reqtarpit <search>
11205 - reqitarpit <search>
11206 - rspadd <string>
11207 - rspdel <search>
11208 - rspidel <search>
11209 - rspdeny <search>
11210 - rspideny <search>
11211 - rsprep <search> <replace>
11212 - rspirep <search> <replace>
11213
11214With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
11215is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
11216parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
11217prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
11218Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
11219
11220 \t for a tab
11221 \r for a carriage return (CR)
11222 \n for a new line (LF)
11223 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
11224 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
11225 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
11226 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
11227 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
11228
11229The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
11230portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
11231above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
11232regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
112339 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
11234is very common to users of the "sed" program.
11235
11236The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
11237after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
11238
11239Notes related to these keywords :
11240---------------------------------
11241 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
11242 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
11243 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
11244
11245 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
11246 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
11247 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
11248
11249 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
11250 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
11251 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
11252 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
11253 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
11254
11255 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
11256 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
11257 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
11258 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
11259 useless headers before adding new ones.
11260
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011261 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011262 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
11263
11264 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
11265 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
11266 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
11267
11268 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
11269 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011270 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011271
11272
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200112737. Using ACLs and fetching samples
11274----------------------------------
11275
11276Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
11277client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
11278The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
11279these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
11280but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
11281data called patterns.
11282
11283
112847.1. ACL basics
11285---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011286
11287The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
11288content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
11289from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
11290simple :
11291
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011292 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011293 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011294 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
11295 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011296
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011297The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
11298adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011299
11300In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
11301
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011302 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011303
11304This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
11305Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
11306and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011307an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
11308conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
11309as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
11310are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011311
11312ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
11313'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
11314which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
11315
11316There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
11317performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
11318
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011319The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
11320specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
11321this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011322methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
11323ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011324
11325Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
11326 - boolean
11327 - integer (signed or unsigned)
11328 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
11329 - string
11330 - data block
11331
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011332Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
11333converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
11334would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
11335The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
11336which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
11337
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011338Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
11339keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
11340fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
11341which are summarized in the table below :
11342
11343 +---------------------+-----------------+
11344 | Sample or converter | Default |
11345 | output type | matching method |
11346 +---------------------+-----------------+
11347 | boolean | bool |
11348 +---------------------+-----------------+
11349 | integer | int |
11350 +---------------------+-----------------+
11351 | ip | ip |
11352 +---------------------+-----------------+
11353 | string | str |
11354 +---------------------+-----------------+
11355 | binary | none, use "-m" |
11356 +---------------------+-----------------+
11357
11358Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
11359matching method, see below.
11360
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011361The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
11362 - boolean
11363 - integer or integer range
11364 - IP address / network
11365 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
11366 - regular expression
11367 - hex block
11368
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011369The following ACL flags are currently supported :
11370
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011371 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
11372 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011373 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010011374 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010011375 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010011376 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011377 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
11378
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011379The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
11380read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
11381if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
11382lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
11383will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
11384beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
11385a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
11386lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
11387exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
11388
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010011389The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
11390parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
11391ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
11392a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
11393check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
11394
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010011395The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
11396socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
11397file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
11398
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011399Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
11400loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
11401
11402 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
11403
11404In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
11405the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
11406case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
11407as well.
11408
11409The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
11410sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
11411do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
11412methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
11413is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
11414obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
11415followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
11416default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
11417that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
11418string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
11419
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010011420The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
11421By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
11422string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
11423resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
11424server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
11425waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
11426flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
11427function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
11428
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011429There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
11430sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
11431be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011432
11433 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
11434 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011435 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
11436 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
11437 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
11438 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011439
11440 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
11441 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011442 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011443
11444 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011445 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011446
11447 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011448 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011449
11450 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
11451 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
11452
11453 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
11454 binary or string samples.
11455
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011456 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
11457 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011458
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011459 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
11460 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
11461 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011462
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011463 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
11464 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011465
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011466 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
11467 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011468
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011469 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
11470 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011471
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011472 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
11473 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011474 This may be used with binary or string samples.
11475
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011476 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
11477 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
11478 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011479
11480For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
11481request, it is possible to do :
11482
11483 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
11484
11485In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
11486buffer, one would use the following acl :
11487
11488 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
11489
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011490On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
11491possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
11492
11493 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
11494
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011495All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
11496criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
11497method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
11498to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
11499criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
11500the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011501
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011502If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011503the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
11504For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011505
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011506 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
11507 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
11508 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
11509 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011510
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011511
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011512The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
11513types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
11514combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
11515brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
11516default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011517
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011518 +-------------------------------------------------+
11519 | Input sample type |
11520 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011521 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011522 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
11523 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
11524 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011525 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011526 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011527 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011528 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011529 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011530 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011531 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011532 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011533 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011534 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011535 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011536 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011537 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011538 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011539 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011540 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011541 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011542 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011543 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011544 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011545 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011546 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
11547 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
11548 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011549
11550
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200115517.1.1. Matching booleans
11552------------------------
11553
11554In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
11555Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
11556When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
11557that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
11558
11559Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
11560return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
11561"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
11562
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011563
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200115647.1.2. Matching integers
11565------------------------
11566
11567Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
11568enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
11569to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
11570
11571Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
11572matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
11573lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011574
11575For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
11576unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
11577representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
11578
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011579As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
11580two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
11581instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
11582ranges and operators.
11583
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011584For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011585operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
11586Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
11587of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011588
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011589Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011590
11591 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
11592 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
11593 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
11594 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
11595 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
11596
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011597For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011598
11599 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
11600
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011601This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
11602
11603 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
11604
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011605
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200116067.1.3. Matching strings
11607-----------------------
11608
11609String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
11610different forms :
11611
11612 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
11613 patterns ;
11614
11615 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
11616 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
11617
11618 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
11619 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
11620
11621 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
11622 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
11623
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010011624 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011625 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
11626 matches.
11627
11628 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
11629 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
11630 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011631
11632String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
11633exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
11634characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
11635string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
11636to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011637before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011638
11639
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200116407.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
11641---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011642
11643Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
11644they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
11645possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
11646passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
11647the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011648the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
11649match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011650
11651
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200116527.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
11653-------------------------------------
11654
11655It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
11656not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
11657a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
11658to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
11659digits may be used upper or lower case.
11660
11661Example :
11662 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
11663 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
11664
11665
116667.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
11667---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011668
11669IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
11670netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
11671within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011672host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011673difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
11674at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
11675does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
11676parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011677
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020011678The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
11679abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
11680
11681 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
11682 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
11683 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
11684 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
11685 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
11686 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
11687 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
11688 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
11689
11690Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
11691192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
11692
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020011693IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
11694Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
11695trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
11696IPv6 patterns.
11697
11698HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
11699following situations :
11700 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
11701 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
11702 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
11703 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
11704 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
11705 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
11706 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
11707 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
11708 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
11709 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
11710
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011711
117127.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
11713----------------------------------
11714
11715Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
11716combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
11717
11718 - AND (implicit)
11719 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
11720 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011721
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011722A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011723
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011724 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020011725
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011726Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
11727indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020011728
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011729For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
11730"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
11731requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
11732is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
11733
11734 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
11735 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
11736 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
11737 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
11738
11739To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
11740and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
11741
11742 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
11743 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
11744 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
11745 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
11746
11747 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
11748 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
11749 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
11750 use_backend www if host_www
11751
11752It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
11753expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
11754be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
11755the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
11756
11757 The following rule :
11758
11759 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
11760 block if METH_POST missing_cl
11761
11762 Can also be written that way :
11763
11764 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
11765
11766It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
11767to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
11768simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
11769sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
11770good use is the following :
11771
11772 With named ACLs :
11773
11774 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
11775 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
11776 monitor fail if site_dead
11777
11778 With anonymous ACLs :
11779
11780 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
11781
11782See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
11783
11784
117857.3. Fetching samples
11786---------------------
11787
11788Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
11789against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
11790sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
11791ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
11792of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
11793available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
11794
11795This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
11796Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
11797compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
11798deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
11799
11800The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
11801matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
11802method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
11803indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
11804
11805As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
11806when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
11807mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
11808the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
11809ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
11810
11811Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
11812multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
11813when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
11814incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
11815are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
11816is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
11817all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
11818
11819Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
11820 - name
11821 - name(arg1)
11822 - name(arg1,arg2)
11823
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011824
118257.3.1. Converters
11826-----------------
11827
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011828Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
11829of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
11830is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
11831was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
11832has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
11833unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
11834
11835These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
11836sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
11837the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
11838support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011839
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011840A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
11841support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
11842supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
11843(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
11844bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
11845
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011846The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011847
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011848add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011849 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011850 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011851 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
11852 scopes allowed are:
11853 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11854 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
11855 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
11856 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
11857 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011858 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011859
11860and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011861 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011862 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011863 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
11864 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
11865 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11866 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
11867 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
11868 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
11869 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011870 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011871
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020011872base64
11873 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
11874 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
11875 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
11876
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011877bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011878 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011879 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
11880 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
11881 presence of a flag).
11882
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010011883bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
11884 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
11885 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
11886 optionnaly truncated at the given length.
11887
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011888cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011889 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
11890 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011891
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010011892crc32([<avalanche>])
11893 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
11894 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
11895 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
11896 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
11897 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
11898 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
11899 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
11900 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
11901 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
11902 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
11903 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6" and the "hash-type" directive.
11904
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010011905da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020011906 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
11907 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
11908 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
11909 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000011910 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020011911 configuration language.
11912
11913 Example:
11914 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020011915 bind *:8881
11916 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000011917 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020011918
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020011919debug
11920 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
11921 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
11922 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
11923
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011924div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011925 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
11926 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011927 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011928 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11929 scope. The scopes allowed are:
11930 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11931 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
11932 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
11933 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
11934 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011935 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011936
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011937djb2([<avalanche>])
11938 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
11939 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
11940 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
11941 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
11942 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
11943 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
11944 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010011945 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6" and the
11946 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011947
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011948even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011949 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011950 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
11951
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010011952field(<index>,<delimiters>)
11953 Extracts the substring at the given index considering given delimiters from
11954 an input string. Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted
11955 list of chars.
11956
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011957hex
11958 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
11959 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
11960 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
11961 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010011962
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011963http_date([<offset>])
11964 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
11965 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
11966 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
11967 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
11968 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
11969 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011970
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020011971in_table(<table>)
11972 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11973 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
11974 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
11975 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (eg: whether
11976 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
11977
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020011978ipmask(<mask>)
11979 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
11980 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
11981 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
11982 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
11983
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020011984json([<input-code>])
11985 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII ouput string ready to use as a
11986 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020011987 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020011988 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
11989 of errors:
11990 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
11991 bytes, ...)
11992 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
11993 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
11994
11995 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
11996 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
11997 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
11998 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
11999 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
12000 are :
12001 - "ascii" : never fails ;
12002 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors ;
12003 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors ;
12004 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
12005 error ;
12006 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
12007 characters corresponding to the other errors.
12008
12009 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
12010 logging to servers which consume JSON-formated traffic logs.
12011
12012 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012013 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020012014 capture request header user-agent len 150
12015 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012016
12017 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
12018 GET / HTTP/1.0
12019 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
12020
12021 Output log:
12022 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
12023
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012024language(<value>[,<default>])
12025 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
12026 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
12027 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
12028 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
12029 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
12030 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
12031 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
12032 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
12033 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
12034 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
12035 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
12036 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012037
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012038 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012039
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012040 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
12041 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012042
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012043 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
12044 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
12045 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
12046 use_backend spanish if es
12047 use_backend french if fr
12048 use_backend english if en
12049 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012050
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012051lower
12052 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
12053 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
12054 type. The result is of type string.
12055
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020012056ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
12057 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12058 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
12059 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
12060 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
12061 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
12062 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
12063
12064 Example :
12065
12066 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
12067 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
12068 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
12069
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012070map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12071map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12072map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12073 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
12074 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
12075 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
12076 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
12077 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
12078 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
12079 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
12080 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012081
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012082 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
12083 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
12084 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012085
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012086 The following array contains the list of all map functions avalaible sorted by
12087 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012088
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012089 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
12090 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12091 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
12092 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020012093 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
12094 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012095 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
12096 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12097 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
12098 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12099 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
12100 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12101 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
12102 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010012103 | | map_reg | |
12104 str | reg +-----------------+ map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
12105 | | map_regm | |
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012106 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12107 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
12108 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12109 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
12110 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012111
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010012112 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
12113 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
12114 the corresponding match text.
12115
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012116 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
12117 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
12118 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
12119 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
12120 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012121
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012122 Example :
12123
12124 # this is a comment and is ignored
12125 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
12126 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
12127 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
12128 | | | `---------- value
12129 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
12130 | `---------------------------- key
12131 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
12132
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012133mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012134 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
12135 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012136 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012137 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12138 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12139 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12140 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12141 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12142 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012143 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012144
12145mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012146 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020012147 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
12148 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012149 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012150 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12151 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12152 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12153 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12154 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12155 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012156 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012157
12158neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012159 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
12160 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
12161 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
12162 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012163
12164not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012165 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012166 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
12167 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
12168 absence of a flag).
12169
12170odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012171 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012172 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
12173
12174or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012175 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012176 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012177 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
12178 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12179 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12180 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12181 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12182 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12183 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012184 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012185
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010012186regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010012187 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
12188 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
12189 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
12190 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
12191 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
12192 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
12193 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
12194 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
12195 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
12196 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010012197 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
12198 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
12199 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
12200 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010012201
12202 Example :
12203
12204 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
12205 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
12206 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
12207 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
12208
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012209capture-req(<id>)
12210 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
12211 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
12212
12213 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020012214 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
12215 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012216
12217capture-res(<id>)
12218 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
12219 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
12220
12221 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020012222 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
12223 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012224
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012225sdbm([<avalanche>])
12226 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
12227 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12228 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12229 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12230 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12231 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
12232 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012233 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6" and the
12234 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012235
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012236set-var(<var name>)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012237 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output as
12238 is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of the
12239 variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12240 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12241 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012242 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012243 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12244 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012245 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
12246 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
12247
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012248sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012249 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
12250 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012251 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012252 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12253 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12254 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12255 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012256 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012257 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12258 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012259 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
12260 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012261
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012262table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
12263 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12264 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12265 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
12266 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
12267 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
12268 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
12269
12270
12271table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
12272 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12273 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12274 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
12275 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
12276 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
12277 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
12278
12279table_conn_cnt(<table>)
12280 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12281 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12282 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
12283 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
12284 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
12285
12286table_conn_cur(<table>)
12287 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12288 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12289 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
12290 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
12291 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
12292
12293table_conn_rate(<table>)
12294 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12295 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12296 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
12297 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
12298 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
12299
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012300table_gpt0(<table>)
12301 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12302 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
12303 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
12304 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
12305 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
12306
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012307table_gpc0(<table>)
12308 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12309 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12310 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
12311 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
12312 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
12313
12314table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
12315 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12316 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12317 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
12318 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
12319 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
12320 sample fetch keyword.
12321
12322table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
12323 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12324 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12325 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
12326 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
12327 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
12328
12329table_http_err_rate(<table>)
12330 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12331 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12332 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
12333 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
12334 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
12335 keyword.
12336
12337table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
12338 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12339 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12340 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
12341 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
12342 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
12343
12344table_http_req_rate(<table>)
12345 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12346 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12347 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
12348 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
12349 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
12350 keyword.
12351
12352table_kbytes_in(<table>)
12353 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12354 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12355 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of client-
12356 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
12357 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
12358 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
12359 keyword.
12360
12361table_kbytes_out(<table>)
12362 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12363 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12364 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of server-
12365 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
12366 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
12367 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
12368 keyword.
12369
12370table_server_id(<table>)
12371 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12372 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12373 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
12374 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
12375 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
12376 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
12377
12378table_sess_cnt(<table>)
12379 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12380 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12381 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
12382 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
12383 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
12384 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
12385 keyword.
12386
12387table_sess_rate(<table>)
12388 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12389 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12390 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
12391 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
12392 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
12393 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
12394 keyword.
12395
12396table_trackers(<table>)
12397 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12398 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12399 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
12400 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
12401 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
12402 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
12403 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
12404 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
12405 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
12406 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
12407
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012408upper
12409 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
12410 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
12411 type. The result is of type string.
12412
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020012413url_dec
12414 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
12415 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
12416
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020012417utime(<format>[,<offset>])
12418 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12419 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
12420 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
12421 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
12422 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
12423 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
12424
12425 Example :
12426
12427 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
12428 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
12429 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
12430
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010012431word(<index>,<delimiters>)
12432 Extracts the nth word considering given delimiters from an input string.
12433 Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
12434
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012435wt6([<avalanche>])
12436 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
12437 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12438 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12439 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12440 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12441 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
12442 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012443 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", and the
12444 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012445
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012446xor(<value>)
12447 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012448 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012449 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012450 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12451 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12452 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012453 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012454 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12455 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012456 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
12457 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012458
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012459
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200124607.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012461--------------------------------------------
12462
12463A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
12464not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
12465"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
12466The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
12467
12468always_false : boolean
12469 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
12470 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
12471
12472always_true : boolean
12473 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
12474 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
12475
12476avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012477 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012478 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
12479 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
12480 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
12481 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
12482 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
12483 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
12484 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
12485 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
12486 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
12487 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
12488 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
12489 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
12490 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010012491
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012492be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020012493 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
12494 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
12495 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
12496 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
12497 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012498
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012499be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
12500 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
12501 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
12502 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
12503 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
12504 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
12505 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012506
12507 Example :
12508 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
12509 backend dynamic
12510 mode http
12511 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
12512 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012513
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020012514bin(<hexa>) : bin
12515 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
12516 of the string.
12517
12518bool(<bool>) : bool
12519 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
12520 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
12521
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012522connslots([<backend>]) : integer
12523 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012524 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012525 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
12526 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050012527
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012528 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012529 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012530 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
12531
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012532 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
12533 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012534
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020012535 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012536 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012537 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012538 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
12539 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012540 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020012541 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012542
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012543 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
12544 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012545 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012546 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012547
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020012548date([<offset>]) : integer
12549 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
12550 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
12551 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
12552 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020012553 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
12554
12555 Example :
12556
12557 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
12558 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020012559
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020012560env(<name>) : string
12561 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
12562 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
12563 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
12564 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
12565 certain way.
12566
12567 Examples :
12568 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
12569 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
12570
12571 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
12572 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
12573
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012574fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
12575 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012576 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
12577 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012578 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
12579 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
12580 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
12581 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
12582 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020012583
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020012584fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
12585 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
12586 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
12587 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
12588
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012589fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
12590 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
12591 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
12592 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
12593 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
12594 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
12595 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
12596 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
12597 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010012598
12599 Example :
12600 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
12601 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
12602 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
12603 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
12604 frontend mail
12605 bind :25
12606 mode tcp
12607 maxconn 100
12608 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
12609 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
12610 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
12611 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012612
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012613int(<integer>) : signed integer
12614 Returns a signed integer.
12615
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020012616ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
12617 Returns an ipv4.
12618
12619ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
12620 Returns an ipv6.
12621
12622meth(<method>) : method
12623 Returns a method.
12624
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010012625nbproc : integer
12626 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
12627 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
12628 and debugging purposes.
12629
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012630nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
12631 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
12632 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
12633 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012634 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
12635 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
12636 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010012637
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010012638proc : integer
12639 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
12640 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
12641 debugging purposes.
12642
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012643queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012644 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
12645 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
12646 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012647 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
12648 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
12649 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
12650 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
12651 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
12652
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010012653rand([<range>]) : integer
12654 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
12655 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
12656 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
12657 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
12658 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
12659
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012660srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
12661 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
12662 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
12663 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
12664 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
12665 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
12666 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
12667 methods.
12668
12669srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
12670 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
12671 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
12672 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
12673 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
12674 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
12675 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
12676 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
12677
12678srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
12679 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
12680 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012681 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012682 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
12683 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
12684 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
12685 overloading servers).
12686
12687 Example :
12688 # Redirect to a separate back
12689 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
12690 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
12691 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
12692
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010012693stopping : boolean
12694 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
12695 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
12696 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
12697
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020012698str(<string>) : string
12699 Returns a string.
12700
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012701table_avl([<table>]) : integer
12702 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
12703 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
12704
12705table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12706 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
12707 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
12708 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
12709
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012710var(<var-name>) : undefined
12711 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012712 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
12713 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12714 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12715 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012716 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012717 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12718 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012719 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
12720 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
12721
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200127227.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012723----------------------------------
12724
12725The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
12726closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
12727methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
12728sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
12729TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012730the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
12731counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
12732"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012733argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
12734the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
12735this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012736
12737be_id : integer
12738 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
12739 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
12740
12741dst : ip
12742 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
12743 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
12744 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
12745 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
12746 RFC 4291.
12747
12748dst_conn : integer
12749 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
12750 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
12751 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
12752 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
12753 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
12754 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
12755 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
12756 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012757
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020012758dst_is_local : boolean
12759 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
12760 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
12761 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
12762 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
12763 targetting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
12764 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
12765 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
12766 it only once per connection.
12767
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012768dst_port : integer
12769 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
12770 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
12771 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
12772 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
12773 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
12774 an HTTP header.
12775
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020012776fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
12777 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
12778 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
12779 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
12780 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
12781 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
12782 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
12783
12784fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
12785 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
12786 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
12787 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
12788 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
12789 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
12790 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
12791
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070012792fc_unacked(<unit>) : integer
12793 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
12794 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
12795 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
12796 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
12797
12798fc_sacked(<unit>) : integer
12799 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
12800 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
12801 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
12802 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
12803
12804fc_retrans(<unit>) : integer
12805 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
12806 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
12807 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
12808 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
12809
12810fc_fackets(<unit>) : integer
12811 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
12812 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
12813 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
12814 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
12815
12816fc_lost(<unit>) : integer
12817 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
12818 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
12819 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
12820 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
12821
12822fc_reordering(<unit>) : integer
12823 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
12824 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
12825 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
12826 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
12827
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012828fe_id : integer
12829 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
12830 backends to check from which backend it was called, or to stick all users
12831 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
12832
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012833sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012834sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
12835sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
12836sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012837 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
12838 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
12839 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
12840
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012841sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012842sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
12843sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
12844sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012845 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
12846 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
12847 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
12848
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012849sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012850sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12851sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12852sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020012853 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
12854 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010012855 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
12856 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
12857 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020012858
12859 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
12860 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012861 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
12862 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
12863 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020012864 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
12865 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
12866
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012867sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012868sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12869sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12870sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012871 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
12872 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
12873
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012874sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012875sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
12876sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
12877sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012878 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
12879 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
12880 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
12881
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012882sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012883sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
12884sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
12885sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012886 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
12887 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
12888 See also src_conn_rate.
12889
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012890sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012891sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12892sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12893sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012894 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012895 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012896
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012897sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
12898sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
12899sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
12900sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
12901 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
12902 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
12903
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012904sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012905sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
12906sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
12907sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012908 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
12909 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
12910 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012911 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
12912 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
12913 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012914
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012915sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012916sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12917sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12918sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012919 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
12920 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
12921 See also src_http_err_cnt.
12922
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012923sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012924sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
12925sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
12926sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012927 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
12928 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
12929 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
12930 src_http_err_rate.
12931
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012932sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012933sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12934sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12935sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012936 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
12937 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
12938 src_http_req_cnt.
12939
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012940sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012941sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
12942sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
12943sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012944 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
12945 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
12946 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
12947 src_http_req_rate.
12948
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012949sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012950sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12951sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12952sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012953 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010012954 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
12955 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
12956 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
12957 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012958
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012959 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
12960 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012961 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
12962
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012963sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012964sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
12965sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
12966sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020012967 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
12968 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
12969 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012970
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012971sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012972sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
12973sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
12974sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020012975 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
12976 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
12977 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012978
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012979sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012980sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12981sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12982sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012983 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
12984 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
12985 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
12986 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012987 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012988 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
12989
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012990sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012991sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
12992sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
12993sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012994 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
12995 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
12996 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
12997 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
12998 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012999 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013000
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013001sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013002sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
13003sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
13004sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020013005 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
13006 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
13007 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
13008
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013009sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013010sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
13011sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
13012sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013013 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
13014 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013015 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013016 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
13017 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013018 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
13019 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
13020 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013021
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013022so_id : integer
13023 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
13024 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
13025 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013026
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013027src : ip
13028 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
13029 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
13030 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
13031 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013032 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
13033 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
13034 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
13035 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013036
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013037 Example:
13038 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
13039 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
13040
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013041src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
13042 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
13043 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
13044 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013045 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013046
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013047src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
13048 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
13049 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013050 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013051 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013052
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013053src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13054 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
13055 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
13056 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
13057 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
13058 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
13059 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013060
13061 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
13062 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
13063 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
13064 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013065 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013066 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
13067 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
13068
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013069src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013070 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013071 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013072 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013073 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013074
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013075src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013076 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013077 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
13078 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013079 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013080
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013081src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
13082 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
13083 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13084 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013085 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013086
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013087src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013088 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013089 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013090 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013091 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013092
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013093src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13094 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
13095 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
13096 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
13097 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
13098
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013099src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013100 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013101 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013102 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
13103 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013104 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
13105 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
13106 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013107
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013108src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13109 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
13110 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013111 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013112 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013113 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013114
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013115src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13116 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
13117 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13118 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
13119 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013120 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013121
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013122src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13123 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
13124 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
13125 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013126 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013127
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013128src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
13129 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
13130 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
13131 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013132 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013133 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013134
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013135src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13136 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
13137 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
13138 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013139 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013140 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
13141 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013142
13143 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013144 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013145 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013146
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020013147src_is_local : boolean
13148 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
13149 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
13150 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
13151 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
13152 client comes from (eg: require auth or https for remote machines). Please
13153 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
13154 once per connection.
13155
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013156src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013157 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
13158 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
13159 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
13160 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
13161 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013162
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013163src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013164 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
13165 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13166 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
13167 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
13168 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020013169
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013170src_port : integer
13171 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
13172 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
13173 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
13174 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010013175
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013176src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13177 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013178 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
13179 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
13180 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013181 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013182
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013183src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
13184 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
13185 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13186 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
13187 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013188 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013189
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013190src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13191 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
13192 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
13193 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
13194 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
13195 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
13196 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
13197 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
13198 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020013199
13200 Example :
13201 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
13202 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
13203 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
13204 listen ssh
13205 bind :22
13206 mode tcp
13207 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013208 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013209 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020013210 server local 127.0.0.1:22
13211
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013212srv_id : integer
13213 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
13214 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
13215 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020013216
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200132177.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013218----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020013219
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013220The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
13221closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
13222when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
13223usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013224future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020013225
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020013226ssl_bc : boolean
13227 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
13228 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
13229 other a server with the "ssl" option.
13230
13231ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
13232 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
13233 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13234
13235ssl_bc_cipher : string
13236 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
13237 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13238
13239ssl_bc_protocol : string
13240 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
13241 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13242
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013243ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020013244 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013245 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
13246 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020013247
13248ssl_bc_session_id : binary
13249 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
13250 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
13251 if session was reused or not.
13252
13253ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
13254 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
13255 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13256
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013257ssl_c_ca_err : integer
13258 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13259 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
13260 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
13261 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
13262 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020013263
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013264ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
13265 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13266 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
13267 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
13268 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013269
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010013270ssl_c_der : binary
13271 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
13272 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13273 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
13274
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013275ssl_c_err : integer
13276 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13277 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
13278 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
13279 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
13280 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013281
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013282ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13283 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13284 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
13285 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13286 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
13287 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
13288 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13289 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13290 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013291
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013292ssl_c_key_alg : string
13293 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
13294 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13295 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013296
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013297ssl_c_notafter : string
13298 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
13299 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13300 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020013301
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013302ssl_c_notbefore : string
13303 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
13304 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13305 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010013306
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013307ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13308 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13309 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
13310 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13311 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
13312 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
13313 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13314 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13315 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010013316
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013317ssl_c_serial : binary
13318 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
13319 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13320 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013321
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013322ssl_c_sha1 : binary
13323 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
13324 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
13325 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020013326 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
13327 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
13328
13329 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013330
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013331ssl_c_sig_alg : string
13332 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
13333 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
13334 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013335
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013336ssl_c_used : boolean
13337 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
13338 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020013339
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013340ssl_c_verify : integer
13341 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
13342 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
13343 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
13344 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020013345
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013346ssl_c_version : integer
13347 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
13348 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020013349
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010013350ssl_f_der : binary
13351 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
13352 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13353 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
13354
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013355ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13356 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13357 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
13358 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13359 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013360 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013361 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13362 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13363 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013364
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013365ssl_f_key_alg : string
13366 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
13367 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
13368 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020013369
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013370ssl_f_notafter : string
13371 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
13372 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13373 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013374
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013375ssl_f_notbefore : string
13376 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
13377 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13378 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013379
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013380ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13381 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13382 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
13383 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13384 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
13385 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
13386 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13387 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13388 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020013389
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013390ssl_f_serial : binary
13391 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
13392 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13393 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013394
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020013395ssl_f_sha1 : binary
13396 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
13397 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
13398 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
13399
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013400ssl_f_sig_alg : string
13401 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
13402 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
13403 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020013404
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013405ssl_f_version : integer
13406 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
13407 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13408
13409ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013410 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
13411 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
13412 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
13413
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013414 Example :
13415 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
13416 listen http-https
13417 bind :80
13418 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
13419 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
13420
13421ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
13422 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
13423 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13424
13425ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013426 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013427 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
13428 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
13429 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
13430 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
13431 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
13432 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
13433 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
13434 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
13435
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013436ssl_fc_cipher : string
13437 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
13438 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013439
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013440ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013441 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
13442 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010013443 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
13444 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
13445 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
13446 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013447
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013448ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
13449 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020013450 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
13451 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
13452 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
13453 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020013454
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020013455ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020013456 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
13457 SSL session cache or TLS tickets.
13458
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013459ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013460 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013461 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
13462 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
13463 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
13464 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
13465 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
13466 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
13467 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020013468
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013469ssl_fc_protocol : string
13470 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
13471 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020013472
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013473ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040013474 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013475 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
13476 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040013477
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013478ssl_fc_session_id : binary
13479 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
13480 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
13481 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
13482 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020013483
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013484ssl_fc_sni : string
13485 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
13486 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
13487 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
13488 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
13489 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
13490
13491 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
13492 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
13493 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020013494 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
13495 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013496
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013497 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013498 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
13499 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020013500
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013501ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
13502 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
13503 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020013504
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020013505
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200135067.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013507------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020013508
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013509Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
13510sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
13511only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
13512For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
13513be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
13514can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
13515sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
13516for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
13517content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013518
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013519payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
13520 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
13521 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
13522 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013523
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013524payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
13525 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
13526 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
13527 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013528
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013529req.len : integer
13530req_len : integer (deprecated)
13531 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
13532 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
13533 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
13534 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
13535 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
13536 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
13537 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
13538 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013539
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013540req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
13541 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020013542 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
13543 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
13544 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
13545 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013546
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013547 ACL alternatives :
13548 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013549
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013550req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
13551 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
13552 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
13553 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
13554 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013555
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013556 ACL alternatives :
13557 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013558
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013559 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013560
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013561req.proto_http : boolean
13562req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
13563 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
13564 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
13565 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
13566 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
13567 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
13568 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
13569 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013570
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013571 Example:
13572 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
13573 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
13574 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013575 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013576
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013577req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
13578rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
13579 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
13580 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
13581 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
13582 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
13583 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
13584 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
13585 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013586
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013587 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
13588 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
13589 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
13590 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
13591 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
13592 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013593
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013594 ACL derivatives :
13595 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013596
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013597 Example :
13598 listen tse-farm
13599 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
13600 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
13601 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
13602 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
13603 # apply RDP cookie persistence
13604 persist rdp-cookie
13605 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
13606 # This is only useful makes sense if
13607 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
13608 stick-table type string size 204800
13609 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
13610 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
13611 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013612
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013613 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
13614 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013615
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013616req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
13617rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
13618 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
13619 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
13620 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
13621 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013622
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013623 ACL derivatives :
13624 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013625
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020013626req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
13627 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
13628 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020013629 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
13630 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
13631 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
13632 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
13633 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020013634
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013635req.ssl_hello_type : integer
13636req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
13637 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
13638 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
13639 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
13640 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
13641 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
13642 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
13643 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013644
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013645req.ssl_sni : string
13646req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
13647 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
13648 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
13649 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
13650 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
13651 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
13652 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
13653 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
13654 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
13655 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
13656 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
13657 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
13658 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013659
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013660 ACL derivatives :
13661 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013662
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013663 Examples :
13664 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
13665 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
13666 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
13667 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
13668 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013669
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053013670req.ssl_st_ext : integer
13671 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
13672 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
13673 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
13674 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
13675 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
13676 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
13677 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
13678 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
13679 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
13680
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013681req.ssl_ver : integer
13682req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
13683 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
13684 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
13685 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
13686 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
13687 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
13688 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
13689 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
13690 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
13691 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013692
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013693 ACL derivatives :
13694 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013695
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020013696res.len : integer
13697 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
13698 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
13699 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
13700 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
13701 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
13702 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
13703 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
13704 content inspection.
13705
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013706res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
13707 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020013708 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
13709 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
13710 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
13711 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013712
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013713res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
13714 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
13715 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
13716 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
13717 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013718
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013719 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013720
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020013721res.ssl_hello_type : integer
13722rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
13723 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
13724 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
13725 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
13726 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
13727 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
13728 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
13729 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
13730
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013731wait_end : boolean
13732 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
13733 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
13734 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
13735 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
13736 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
13737 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
13738 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
13739 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013740
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013741 Examples :
13742 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
13743 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
13744 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013745
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013746 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
13747 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
13748 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
13749 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
13750 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
13751 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
13752 tcp-request content reject
13753
13754
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200137557.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013756--------------------------------------
13757
13758It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
13759This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
13760data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
13761its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
13762HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
13763content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
13764to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
13765more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
13766response are indexed.
13767
13768base : string
13769 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
13770 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
13771 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
13772 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
13773 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
13774 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
13775 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
13776 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
13777
13778 ACL derivatives :
13779 base : exact string match
13780 base_beg : prefix match
13781 base_dir : subdir match
13782 base_dom : domain match
13783 base_end : suffix match
13784 base_len : length match
13785 base_reg : regex match
13786 base_sub : substring match
13787
13788base32 : integer
13789 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
13790 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
13791 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013792 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
13793 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
13794 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013795
13796base32+src : binary
13797 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
13798 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
13799 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
13800 per-URL counters.
13801
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010013802capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
13803 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
13804 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
13805 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
13806
13807capture.req.method : string
13808 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
13809 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
13810 because it's allocated.
13811
13812capture.req.uri : string
13813 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
13814 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
13815 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
13816 allocated.
13817
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020013818capture.req.ver : string
13819 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
13820 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
13821 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
13822
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010013823capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
13824 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
13825 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
13826 The first entry is an index of 0.
13827 See also: "capture response header"
13828
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020013829capture.res.ver : string
13830 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
13831 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
13832 persistent flag.
13833
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020013834req.body : binary
13835 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
13836 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
13837 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
13838 the first chunk is analyzed.
13839
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020013840req.body_param([<name>) : string
13841 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
13842 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
13843 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
13844 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
13845 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
13846 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
13847 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
13848 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
13849 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
13850 given.
13851
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020013852req.body_len : integer
13853 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
13854 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
13855 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
13856 "option http-buffer-request".
13857
13858req.body_size : integer
13859 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
13860 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
13861 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
13862 that the request body has been buffered made available using
13863 "option http-buffer-request".
13864
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013865req.cook([<name>]) : string
13866cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
13867 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
13868 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
13869 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
13870 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
13871 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
13872 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
13873 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
13874 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
13875
13876 ACL derivatives :
13877 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
13878 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
13879 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
13880 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
13881 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
13882 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
13883 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
13884 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013885
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013886req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
13887cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
13888 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
13889 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013890
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013891req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
13892cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
13893 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
13894 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
13895 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
13896 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020013897
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013898cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
13899 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
13900 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
13901 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
13902 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020013903 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013904 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
13905 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
13906 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
13907 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013908
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013909hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
13910 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
13911 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
13912 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
13913 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013914 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013915
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013916req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
13917 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
13918 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
13919 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
13920 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
13921 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
13922 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
13923 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
13924 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013925
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013926req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
13927 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
13928 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
13929 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
13930 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013931
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013932req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
13933 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
13934 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
13935 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
13936 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
13937 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
13938 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
13939 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
13940 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
13941 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
13942 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
13943 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013944
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013945 ACL derivatives :
13946 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
13947 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
13948 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
13949 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
13950 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
13951 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
13952 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
13953 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
13954
13955req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
13956hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
13957 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
13958 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
13959 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
13960 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
13961 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
13962 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
13963 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
13964 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
13965 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
13966
13967req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
13968hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
13969 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
13970 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
13971 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
13972 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
13973 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
13974 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
13975 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
13976 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
13977
13978req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
13979hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
13980 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
13981 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
13982 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
13983 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
13984 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
13985 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
13986 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
13987
13988http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
13989 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
13990 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
13991 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
13992 basic auth is supported.
13993
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010013994http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
13995 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
13996 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
13997 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
13998 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013999 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
14000 basic auth is supported.
14001
14002 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010014003 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
14004 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
14005 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
14006 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014007
14008http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020014009 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
14010 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014011 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
14012 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020014013
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014014method : integer + string
14015 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
14016 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
14017 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
14018 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
14019 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
14020 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
14021 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014022
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014023 ACL derivatives :
14024 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014025
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014026 Example :
14027 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
14028 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
14029 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014030
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014031path : string
14032 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
14033 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
14034 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
14035 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
14036 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
14037 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
14038 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014039
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014040 ACL derivatives :
14041 path : exact string match
14042 path_beg : prefix match
14043 path_dir : subdir match
14044 path_dom : domain match
14045 path_end : suffix match
14046 path_len : length match
14047 path_reg : regex match
14048 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014049
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010014050query : string
14051 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
14052 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
14053 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
14054 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
14055 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the completemnt of "path"
14056 which stops before the question mark.
14057
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010014058req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
14059 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
14060 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
14061 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
14062 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
14063
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014064req.ver : string
14065req_ver : string (deprecated)
14066 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
14067 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
14068 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014069
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014070 ACL derivatives :
14071 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020014072
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014073res.comp : boolean
14074 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
14075 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
14076 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014077
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014078res.comp_algo : string
14079 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
14080 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
14081 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014082
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014083res.cook([<name>]) : string
14084scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14085 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
14086 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
14087 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020014088
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014089 ACL derivatives :
14090 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020014091
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014092res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14093scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14094 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
14095 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
14096 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014097
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014098res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
14099scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14100 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
14101 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
14102 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014103
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014104res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14105 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
14106 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
14107 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
14108 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
14109 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
14110 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
14111 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
14112 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
14113 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014114
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014115res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14116 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
14117 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
14118 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
14119 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
14120 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014121
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014122res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14123shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
14124 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
14125 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
14126 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
14127 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
14128 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
14129 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
14130 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
14131 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014132
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014133 ACL derivatives :
14134 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
14135 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
14136 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
14137 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
14138 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
14139 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
14140 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
14141 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
14142
14143res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14144shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14145 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
14146 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
14147 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
14148 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
14149 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014150
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014151res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
14152shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
14153 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
14154 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
14155 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
14156 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
14157 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
14158 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014159
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010014160res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
14161 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
14162 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
14163 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
14164 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
14165
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014166res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
14167shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
14168 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
14169 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
14170 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
14171 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
14172 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
14173 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010014174
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014175res.ver : string
14176resp_ver : string (deprecated)
14177 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
14178 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020014179
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014180 ACL derivatives :
14181 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010014182
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014183set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14184 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
14185 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020014186 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014187 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010014188
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014189 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
14190 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010014191
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014192status : integer
14193 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
14194 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
14195 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014196
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020014197unique-id : string
14198 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
14199 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
14200 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
14201 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
14202 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
14203 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
14204
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014205url : string
14206 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
14207 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
14208 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
14209 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
14210 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
14211 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
14212 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014213
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014214 ACL derivatives :
14215 url : exact string match
14216 url_beg : prefix match
14217 url_dir : subdir match
14218 url_dom : domain match
14219 url_end : suffix match
14220 url_len : length match
14221 url_reg : regex match
14222 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014223
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014224url_ip : ip
14225 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
14226 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
14227 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
14228 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
14229 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
14230 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
14231 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014232
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014233url_port : integer
14234 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
14235 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
14236 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
14237 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014238
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014239urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
14240url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014241 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
14242 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014243 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
14244 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
14245 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
14246 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014247 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
14248 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014249 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
14250 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014251
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014252 ACL derivatives :
14253 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
14254 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
14255 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
14256 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
14257 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
14258 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
14259 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
14260 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014261
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014262
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014263 Example :
14264 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
14265 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
14266 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
14267 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014268
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014269urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>])] : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014270 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
14271 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
14272 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020014273
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020014274url32 : integer
14275 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
14276 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
14277 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
14278 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
14279 is an unsigned integer.
14280
14281url32+src : binary
14282 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
14283 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
14284 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
14285
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010014286
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200142877.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014288---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010014289
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014290Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
14291every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020014292order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010014293
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014294ACL name Equivalent to Usage
14295---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014296FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020014297HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014298HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
14299HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014300HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
14301HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
14302HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
14303HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
14304LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014305METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020014306METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014307METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
14308METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
14309METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
14310METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020014311METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014312METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020014313RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014314REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014315TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014316WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
14317---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010014318
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010014319
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200143208. Logging
14321----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014322
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014323One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
14324provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
14325very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
14326provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
14327state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014328to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014329headers.
14330
14331In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
14332about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
14333send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
14334
14335 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
14336 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
14337 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
14338 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
14339 at the termination.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060014340 - per-request control of log-level, eg:
14341 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014342
14343The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
14344allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
14345as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
14346while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
14347real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
14348delay.
14349
14350
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200143518.1. Log levels
14352---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014353
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090014354TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014355source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090014356HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
14357in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
14358track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
14359syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
14360about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014361
14362
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200143638.2. Log formats
14364----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014365
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014366HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090014367and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
14368slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
14369options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014370
14371 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
14372 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
14373 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
14374 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
14375 extents.
14376
14377 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
14378 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
14379 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
14380 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
14381 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
14382
14383 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
14384 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
14385 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
14386 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
14387 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
14388
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020014389 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
14390 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
14391 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
14392 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
14393
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014394 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
14395
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014396Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
14397specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
14398field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
14399servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
14400always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
14401identifier.
14402
14403Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
14404 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
14405 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
14406 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
14407 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
14408
14409
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200144108.2.1. Default log format
14411-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014412
14413This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
14414as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
14415format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
14416
14417 Example :
14418 listen www
14419 mode http
14420 log global
14421 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
14422
14423 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
14424 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
14425 (www/HTTP)
14426
14427 Field Format Extract from the example above
14428 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
14429 2 'Connect from' Connect from
14430 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
14431 4 'to' to
14432 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
14433 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
14434
14435Detailed fields description :
14436 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
14437 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
14438 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
14439 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
14440 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
14441 and processed the connection.
14442 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
14443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014444In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
14445"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
14446connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
14447
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014448It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
14449will eventually disappear.
14450
14451
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200144528.2.2. TCP log format
14453---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014454
14455The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
14456is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
14457information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
14458counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
14459emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
14460environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
14461the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
14462sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020014463specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
14464not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
14465fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
14466marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014467
14468 Example :
14469 frontend fnt
14470 mode tcp
14471 option tcplog
14472 log global
14473 default_backend bck
14474
14475 backend bck
14476 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
14477
14478 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
14479 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
14480 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
14481
14482 Field Format Extract from the example above
14483 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
14484 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
14485 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
14486 4 frontend_name fnt
14487 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
14488 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
14489 7 bytes_read* 212
14490 8 termination_state --
14491 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
14492 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
14493
14494Detailed fields description :
14495 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014496 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
14497 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
14498 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014499 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
14500 and the NetScaler Client IP insetion protocol is correctly used, then the
14501 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014502
14503 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014504 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
14505 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
14506 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014507
14508 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
14509 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
14510 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
14511 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
14512
14513 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
14514 and processed the connection.
14515
14516 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
14517 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
14518 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
14519 applications.
14520
14521 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
14522 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
14523 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
14524 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
14525 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
14526
14527 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
14528 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
14529 See "Timers" below for more details.
14530
14531 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
14532 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
14533 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
14534 "Timers" below for more details.
14535
14536 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014537 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014538 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
14539 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
14540 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
14541 details.
14542
14543 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
14544 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
14545 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
14546 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
14547 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
14548
14549 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
14550 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
14551 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
14552 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
14553 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
14554 for more details.
14555
14556 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014557 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014558 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
14559 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
14560 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014561 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014562
14563 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
14564 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
14565 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
14566 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
14567 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
14568 caused by a denial of service attack.
14569
14570 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
14571 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
14572 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
14573 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
14574 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
14575 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
14576 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
14577 denial of service attack.
14578
14579 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
14580 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
14581 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
14582 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
14583 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
14584 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
14585 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
14586 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
14587 be processed than on other servers.
14588
14589 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
14590 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
14591 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
14592 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
14593 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
14594 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
14595 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
14596 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
14597 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
14598 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
14599 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
14600 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
14601 should not be attributed to the logged server.
14602
14603 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
14604 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
14605 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
14606 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
14607 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
14608 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
14609 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
14610 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
14611
14612 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
14613 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
14614 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
14615 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
14616 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
14617 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
14618 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
14619 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
14620 occurs.
14621
14622
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200146238.2.3. HTTP log format
14624----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014625
14626The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
14627is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
14628the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
14629are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
14630emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
14631generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
14632"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
14633which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020014634frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
14635is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014636
14637Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
14638slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
14639with a star ('*') after the field name below.
14640
14641 Example :
14642 frontend http-in
14643 mode http
14644 option httplog
14645 log global
14646 default_backend bck
14647
14648 backend static
14649 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
14650
14651 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
14652 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
14653 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014654 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014655
14656 Field Format Extract from the example above
14657 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
14658 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020014659 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014660 4 frontend_name http-in
14661 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020014662 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014663 7 status_code 200
14664 8 bytes_read* 2750
14665 9 captured_request_cookie -
14666 10 captured_response_cookie -
14667 11 termination_state ----
14668 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
14669 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
14670 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
14671 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
14672 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014673
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014674Detailed fields description :
14675 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014676 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
14677 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
14678 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014679 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
14680 and the NetScaler Client IP insetion protocol is correctly used, then the
14681 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014682
14683 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014684 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
14685 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
14686 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014687
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020014688 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
14689 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014690
14691 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
14692 and processed the connection.
14693
14694 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
14695 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
14696 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
14697
14698 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
14699 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
14700 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
14701 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
14702 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
14703 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
14704
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020014705 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
14706 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
14707 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
14708 request could be received or the a bad request was received. It should
14709 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
14710 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
14711 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See "Timers" below for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014712
14713 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
14714 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
14715 See "Timers" below for more details.
14716
14717 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
14718 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
14719 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
14720 below for more details.
14721
14722 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
14723 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
14724 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
14725 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
14726 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
14727 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
14728 for more details.
14729
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020014730 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
14731 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
14732 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
14733 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
14734 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
14735 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
14736 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
14737 See "Timers" below for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014738
14739 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
14740 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
14741 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
14742
14743 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
14744 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
14745 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
14746 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
14747 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
14748 overflowing.
14749
14750 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
14751 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
14752 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
14753 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
14754 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
14755 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
14756 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
14757 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
14758
14759 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
14760 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
14761 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
14762 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
14763 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
14764 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
14765 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
14766 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
14767
14768 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
14769 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
14770 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
14771 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
14772 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
14773 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
14774 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
14775
14776 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014777 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014778 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
14779 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
14780 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014781 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014782 system.
14783
14784 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
14785 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
14786 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
14787 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
14788 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
14789 caused by a denial of service attack.
14790
14791 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
14792 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
14793 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
14794 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
14795 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
14796 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
14797 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
14798 denial of service attack.
14799
14800 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
14801 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
14802 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
14803 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
14804 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
14805 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
14806 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
14807 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
14808 processed than on other servers.
14809
14810 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
14811 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
14812 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
14813 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
14814 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
14815 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
14816 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
14817 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
14818 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
14819 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
14820 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
14821 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
14822 should not be attributed to the logged server.
14823
14824 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
14825 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
14826 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
14827 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
14828 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
14829 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
14830 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
14831 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
14832
14833 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
14834 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
14835 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
14836 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
14837 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
14838 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
14839 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
14840 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
14841 occurs.
14842
14843 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
14844 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
14845 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
14846 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
14847 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
14848 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
14849 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
14850 cookies" below for more details.
14851
14852 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
14853 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
14854 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
14855 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
14856 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
14857 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
14858 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
14859 and cookies" below for more details.
14860
14861 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
14862 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
14863 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
14864 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
14865 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
14866 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
14867 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
14868 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
14869
14870
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200148718.2.4. Custom log format
14872------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014873
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014874The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014875mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014876
14877HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
14878Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
14879separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
14880prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
14881
14882Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
14883variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010014884("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014885
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010014886If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020014887as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010014888less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
14889the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
14890
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014891Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014892In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010014893in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014894
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010014895Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
14896'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
14897https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
14898such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
14899
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014900Flags are :
14901 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014902 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010014903 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
14904 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014905
14906 Example:
14907
14908 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
14909 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
14910
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010014911 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
14912
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014913At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
14914
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020014915 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
14916 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014917
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014918the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014919
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020014920 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
14921 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
14922 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014923
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014924and the default TCP format is defined this way :
14925
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020014926 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
14927 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014928
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014929Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
14930
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014931 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020014932 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014933 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
14934 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
14935 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014936 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
14937 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
14938 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020014939 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000014940 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
14941 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000014942 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000014943 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
14944 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014945 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020014946 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020014947 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020014948 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014949 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020014950 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080014951 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020014952 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
14953 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
14954 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
14955 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
14956 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020014957 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014958 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
14959 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014960 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014961 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
14962 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014963 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
14964 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
14965 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014966 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014967 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
14968 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014969 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014970 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
14971 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
14972 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020014973 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020014974 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020014975 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
14976 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
14977 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
14978 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020014979 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020014980 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020014981 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014982 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010014983 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014984 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014985 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
14986 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
14987 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014988 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020014989 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
14990 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014991 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020014992 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
14993 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
14994 | H | %trl | locla_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014995 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020014996 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014997 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014998
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020014999 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015000
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010015001
150028.2.5. Error log format
15003-----------------------
15004
15005When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
15006protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
15007By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
15008"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
15009will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
15010logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
15011
15012The format looks like this :
15013
15014 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
15015 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
15016 Connection error during SSL handshake
15017
15018 Field Format Extract from the example above
15019 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
15020 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
15021 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
15022 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
15023 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
15024
15025These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
15026failures.
15027
15028
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200150298.3. Advanced logging options
15030-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015031
15032Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
15033just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
15034options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
15035for more information about their usage.
15036
15037
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200150388.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
15039------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015040
15041It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
15042haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
15043commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
15044monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
15045ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
15046
15047 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
15048 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
15049 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
15050 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
15051
15052 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
15053 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
15054 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015055 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015056 such as other load-balancers.
15057
15058 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
15059 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
15060 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
15061
15062
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200150638.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
15064----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015065
15066The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
15067what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
15068or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
15069"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
15070just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
15071log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
15072after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
15073is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
15074with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
15075with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
15076
15077
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200150788.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
15079------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015080
15081Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
15082for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
15083"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
15084retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
15085raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
15086a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
15087file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
15088you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
15089"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
15090
15091
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200150928.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
15093--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015094
15095Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
15096multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
15097them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
15098"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
15099logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
15100error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
15101and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
15102too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
15103useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
15104alternative.
15105
15106
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200151078.4. Timing events
15108------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015109
15110Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
15111reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
15112the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
15113frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015114mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
15115addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
15116
15117 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
15118 protocols. Currently, these protocoles are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
15119 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
15120 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
15121 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
15122 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (eg: MTU issues), or that an
15123 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015124
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015125 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
15126 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
15127 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
15128 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. Some
15129 browsers pre-establish connections to a server in order to reduce the
15130 latency of a future request, and keep them pending until they need it. This
15131 delay will be reported as the idle time. A value of -1 indicates that
15132 nothing was received on the connection.
15133
15134 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
15135 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
15136 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
15137 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
15138 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
15139 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
15140 request typed by hand during a test.
15141
15142 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
15143 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
15144 exactly equalt to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
15145 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
15146 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
15147 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
15148 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015149
15150 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
15151 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
15152 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
15153 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
15154 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
15155
15156 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
15157 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
15158 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
15159 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
15160 connection never established.
15161
15162 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
15163 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
15164 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
15165 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
15166 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
15167 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
15168 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
15169 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
15170 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
15171 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
15172 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
15173
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015174 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
15175 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
15176 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
15177 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
15178 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
15179 by subtracting other timers when valid :
15180
15181 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
15182
15183 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
15184 "Ta" can never be negative.
15185
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015186 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
15187 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015188 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
15189 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015190 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015191
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015192 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015193
15194 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015195 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
15196 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015197
15198These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
15199protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
15200that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015201due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
15202"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
15203that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015204
15205Most common cases :
15206
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015207 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
15208 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
15209 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
15210 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
15211 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
15212 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
15213 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
15214 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
15215 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
15216 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
15217 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020015218 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015219
15220 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
15221 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
15222 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
15223 of ms on remote networks.
15224
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015225 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
15226 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
15227 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015228
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015229 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
15230 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
15231 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
15232 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
15233 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
15234 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
15235 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
15236 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
15237 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015238
15239Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
15240
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015241 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015242 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015243 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015244
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015245 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015246 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
15247 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
15248
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015249 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015250 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
15251 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
15252 flags.
15253
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015254 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
15255 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015256 Check the session termination flags, then check the
15257 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
15258 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
15259 the client connection was maintained open.
15260
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015261 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015262 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015263 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015264 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
15265
15266
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200152678.5. Session state at disconnection
15268-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015269
15270TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
15271"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
152722-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
15273each of which has a special meaning :
15274
15275 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
15276 session to terminate :
15277
15278 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
15279
15280 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
15281 server explicitly refused it.
15282
15283 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
15284 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
15285 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
15286 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020015287 (eg: cacheable cookie).
15288
15289 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
15290 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015291
15292 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
15293 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
15294 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
15295 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
15296 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
15297
15298 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
15299 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
15300 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
15301 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
15302 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
15303
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090015304 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
15305 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
15306
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070015307 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
15308 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
15309 backup connections when going up.
15310
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020015311 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
15312
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015313 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
15314 send or receive data.
15315
15316 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
15317 send or receive data.
15318
15319 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
15320 with nothing left in the buffers.
15321
15322 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
15323
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010015324 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015325 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
15326
15327 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
15328 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
15329 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
15330 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
15331 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
15332
15333 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
15334 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
15335
15336 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
15337 server (HTTP only).
15338
15339 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
15340
15341 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
15342 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
15343 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
15344
15345 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
15346 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
15347 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
15348
15349 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
15350
15351 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
15352 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
15353
15354 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
15355 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
15356 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
15357
15358 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
15359 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020015360 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
15361 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015362
15363 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
15364 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
15365 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
15366 another server.
15367
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015368 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015369 server.
15370
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015371 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
15372 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
15373 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
15374 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
15375
15376 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
15377 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
15378 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
15379 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
15380
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020015381 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
15382 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
15383 "use-server" rule).
15384
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015385 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
15386
15387 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
15388 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
15389
15390 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
15391
15392 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
15393 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
15394 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
15395
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015396 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
15397 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015398 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015399 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
15400 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
15401
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015402 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
15403
15404 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
15405 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
15406
15407 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
15408
15409 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
15410
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015411The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
15412was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015413helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
15414starvation, attacks, etc...
15415
15416The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
15417alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
15418easier finding and understanding.
15419
15420 Flags Reason
15421
15422 -- Normal termination.
15423
15424 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
15425 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
15426 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
15427 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
15428
15429 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
15430 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
15431 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
15432 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
15433 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
15434 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015435
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015436 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
15437 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020015438 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015439
15440 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
15441 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
15442 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
15443
15444 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
15445 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
15446 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
15447 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
15448 the server takes too long to respond.
15449
15450 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
15451 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
15452 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
15453 long a time to respond.
15454
15455 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
15456 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
15457 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
15458 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020015459 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
15460 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015461
15462 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
15463 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
15464 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
15465 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
15466 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020015467 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020015468 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
15469 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
15470 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
15471 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
15472 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
15473 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
15474 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
15475 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
15476 around the undesirable effects of this behaviour by adding "option
15477 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
15478 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
15479 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015480
15481 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
15482 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015483 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
15484 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
15485 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
15486 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015487
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020015488 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
15489 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
15490
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015491 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015492 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
15493 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
15494 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
15495 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
15496 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
15497
15498 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
15499 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
15500 503 or 504 here.
15501
15502 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
15503 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
15504 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
15505 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
15506 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
15507
15508 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
15509 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015510 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015511 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
15512 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
15513
15514 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
15515 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
15516 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
15517 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
15518 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
15519 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
15520 between haproxy and the server.
15521
15522 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
15523 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
15524 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
15525 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
15526 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
15527 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
15528 solution is to fix the application.
15529
15530 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
15531 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
15532 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
15533 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
15534 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
15535 external attacks.
15536
15537 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
15538 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020015539 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015540 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
15541 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
15542
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010015543 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
15544 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
15545 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020015546 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
15547 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010015548
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015549 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
15550 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
15551 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
15552 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010015553 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
15554 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
15555 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
15556 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
15557 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015558
15559 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
15560 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
15561 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
15562 returned an HTTP 403 error.
15563
15564 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
15565 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
15566 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
15567 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
15568
15569 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
15570 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
15571 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
15572 only be solved by proper system tuning.
15573
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015574The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
15575persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
15576important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
15577re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
15578
15579 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
15580
15581 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
15582 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
15583 set on a GET request.
15584
15585 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
15586 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015587 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015588 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
15589
15590 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
15591 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
15592 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
15593
15594 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
15595 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
15596 already got a cookie.
15597
15598 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
15599 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
15600 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
15601 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
15602 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
15603
15604 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
15605 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
15606 new cookie was inserted in the response.
15607
15608 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
15609 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
15610 new cookie was inserted in the response.
15611
15612 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
15613 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
15614
15615 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
15616 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
15617 then advertised in the response.
15618
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015619
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200156208.6. Non-printable characters
15621-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015622
15623In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
15624consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
15625converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
15626prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
15627being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
15628escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
15629is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
15630'}' when logging headers.
15631
15632Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
15633issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
15634containing spaces is "User-Agent".
15635
15636Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
15637the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
15638performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
15639
15640
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200156418.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
15642---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015643
15644Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
15645achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015646section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015647cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
15648the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
15649the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015650locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015651not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
15652user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
15653a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
15654wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
15655
15656 Examples :
15657 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
15658 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
15659
15660 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
15661 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
15662
15663
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200156648.8. Capturing HTTP headers
15665---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015666
15667Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
15668proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
15669the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
15670server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
15671
15672Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
15673response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015674section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015675
15676It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015677time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
15678appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015679are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
15680and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
15681follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
15682request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
15683in the logs.
15684
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020015685As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
15686frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
15687an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
15688
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015689 Example :
15690 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
15691 listen proxy-out
15692 mode http
15693 option httplog
15694 option logasap
15695 log global
15696 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
15697
15698 # log the name of the virtual server
15699 capture request header Host len 20
15700
15701 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
15702 capture request header Content-Length len 10
15703
15704 # log the beginning of the referrer
15705 capture request header Referer len 20
15706
15707 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
15708 capture response header Server len 20
15709
15710 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
15711 capture response header Content-Length len 10
15712
15713 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
15714 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
15715
15716 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
15717 capture response header Via len 20
15718
15719 # log the URL location during a redirection
15720 capture response header Location len 20
15721
15722 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
15723 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
15724 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
15725 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
15726 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
15727
15728 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
15729 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
15730 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
15731 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015732 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015733
15734 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
15735 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
15736 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
15737 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
15738 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015739 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015740
15741
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200157428.9. Examples of logs
15743---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015744
15745These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
15746them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
15747reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
15748
15749 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
15750 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
15751 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
15752
15753 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
15754 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
15755
15756 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
15757 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
15758 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
15759
15760 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
15761 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
15762
15763 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
15764 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
15765 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
15766
15767 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015768 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015769 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
15770 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
15771
15772 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
15773 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
15774 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
15775
15776 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
15777 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020015778 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015779 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
15780 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
15781 to return the 502 and not the server.
15782
15783 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015784 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015785
15786 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
15787 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
15788 Nothing was sent to any server.
15789
15790 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
15791 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
15792
15793 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
15794 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
15795 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
15796 send a 408 return code to the client.
15797
15798 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
15799 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
15800
15801 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
15802 5 seconds ("c----").
15803
15804 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
15805 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015806 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015807
15808 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015809 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015810 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
15811 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
15812 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
15813 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
15814 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010015815
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020015816
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200158179. Supported filters
15818--------------------
15819
15820Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
15821accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
15822unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
15823
15824See also : "filter"
15825
158269.1. Trace
15827----------
15828
15829filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding]
15830
15831 Arguments:
15832 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
15833 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
15834
15835 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
15836 the client and the server. By default, this filter
15837 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
15838 only parses a random amount of the available data.
15839
15840 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwading of parsed data. By
15841 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
15842 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
15843 amount of the parsed data.
15844
15845This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
15846callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
15847information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
15848filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
15849
15850Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
15851tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
15852a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
15853
15854
158559.2. HTTP compression
15856---------------------
15857
15858filter compression
15859
15860The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
15861keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
15862when no other filter is used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly
15863use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when two or more filters are
15864used for the same listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the
15865filters evaluation order.
15866
15867See also : "compression"
15868
15869
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015870/*
15871 * Local variables:
15872 * fill-column: 79
15873 * End:
15874 */